*** empty log message ***
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob586d0002e8a32e5682138fcbe4927a7a753ad872
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 1999, 2000,01,02,03,04
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
25 #include <config.h>
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
31 #include <stdio.h>
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #define XAW_ARROW_SCROLLBARS
135 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
136 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
138 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
139 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
140 #ifndef XtNpickTop
141 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
142 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
143 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
144 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
146 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
148 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
149 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
151 #endif
153 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
154 #include "widget.h"
155 #ifndef XtNinitialState
156 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
157 #endif
158 #endif
160 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
162 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
163 #ifdef USE_XIM
164 int use_xim = 1;
165 #else
166 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
167 #endif
171 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
173 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
175 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
176 start. */
178 static int any_help_event_p;
180 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
181 static Lisp_Object last_window;
183 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
185 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
187 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
188 use. */
190 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
192 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
193 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
194 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
195 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
197 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
199 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
200 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
201 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
202 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
204 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
206 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
208 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
210 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
211 /* The application context for Xt use. */
212 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
213 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
214 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
216 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
218 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
220 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
221 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
223 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
225 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
226 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
227 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
229 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
231 /* Mouse movement.
233 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
234 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
235 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
236 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
238 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
240 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
241 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
242 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
243 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
244 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
245 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
246 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
247 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
248 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
249 is off. */
251 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
253 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
254 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
256 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
258 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
259 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
260 an ordinary motion.
262 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
263 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
264 event. */
266 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
268 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
269 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
270 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
271 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
272 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
273 it's somewhat accurate. */
275 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
277 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
278 events. */
280 #ifdef __STDC__
281 static int volatile input_signal_count;
282 #else
283 static int input_signal_count;
284 #endif
286 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
288 static int x_noop_count;
290 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
292 extern char **initial_argv;
293 extern int initial_argc;
295 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
297 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
299 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
301 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
303 extern int errno;
305 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
307 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
309 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
311 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
312 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
313 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
315 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
316 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
318 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
319 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
321 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
322 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
323 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
324 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
325 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
326 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
327 unsigned));
328 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
329 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
330 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
331 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
332 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
333 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
334 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
335 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
336 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
337 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
338 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
339 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
340 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
341 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
342 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
343 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
345 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
346 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
347 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
348 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
349 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
350 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
351 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
352 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
353 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
354 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
355 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
356 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
357 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
358 enum text_cursor_kinds));
360 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, GC));
361 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
362 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
363 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
364 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
365 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
366 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
367 enum scroll_bar_part *,
368 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
369 unsigned long *));
370 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
371 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
372 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
373 int *, struct input_event *));
376 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
378 static void
379 x_flush (f)
380 struct frame *f;
382 BLOCK_INPUT;
383 if (f == NULL)
385 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
386 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
387 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
389 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
390 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
391 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
395 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
396 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
397 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
398 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
399 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
400 performance. */
402 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
405 /***********************************************************************
406 Debugging
407 ***********************************************************************/
409 #if 0
411 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
412 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
414 struct record
416 char *locus;
417 int type;
420 struct record event_record[100];
422 int event_record_index;
424 record_event (locus, type)
425 char *locus;
426 int type;
428 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
429 event_record_index = 0;
431 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
432 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
433 event_record_index++;
436 #endif /* 0 */
440 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
442 struct x_display_info *
443 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
444 Display *dpy;
446 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
448 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
449 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
450 return dpyinfo;
452 return 0;
457 /***********************************************************************
458 Starting and ending an update
459 ***********************************************************************/
461 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
462 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
463 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
464 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
465 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
467 static void
468 x_update_begin (f)
469 struct frame *f;
471 /* Nothing to do. */
475 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
476 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
477 position of W. */
479 static void
480 x_update_window_begin (w)
481 struct window *w;
483 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
484 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
486 updated_window = w;
487 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
489 BLOCK_INPUT;
491 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
493 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
494 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
496 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
497 highlighting. */
498 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
499 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
501 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
502 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
503 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
504 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
505 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
506 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
508 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
509 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
510 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
511 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
512 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
513 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
514 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
516 int i;
518 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
519 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
520 break;
522 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
523 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
525 #endif /* 0 */
528 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
532 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
534 static void
535 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
536 struct window *w;
537 int x, y0, y1;
539 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
541 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
542 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
545 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
547 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
548 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
550 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
551 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
552 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
554 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
555 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
556 here. */
558 static void
559 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
560 struct window *w;
561 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
563 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
565 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
567 BLOCK_INPUT;
569 if (cursor_on_p)
570 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
571 output_cursor.vpos,
572 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
574 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
575 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
577 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
580 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
581 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
582 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
584 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
585 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
586 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
589 updated_window = NULL;
593 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
594 update_end. */
596 static void
597 x_update_end (f)
598 struct frame *f;
600 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
601 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
603 #ifndef XFlush
604 BLOCK_INPUT;
605 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
606 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
607 #endif
611 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
612 complete update has been performed. The global variable
613 updated_window is not available here. */
615 static void
616 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
617 struct frame *f;
619 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
621 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
623 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
624 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
626 BLOCK_INPUT;
627 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
628 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
629 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
630 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
631 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
632 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
638 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
639 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
640 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
641 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
642 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
643 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
645 static void
646 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
647 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
649 struct window *w = updated_window;
650 struct frame *f;
651 int width, height;
653 xassert (w);
655 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
656 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
658 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
659 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
660 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
661 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
662 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
663 overhead is very small. */
664 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
665 && desired_row->full_width_p
666 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
667 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
668 width != 0)
669 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
670 height > 0))
672 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
674 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
675 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
676 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
677 y -= width;
679 BLOCK_INPUT;
680 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
681 0, y, width, height, False);
682 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
683 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
684 y, width, height, False);
685 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
689 static void
690 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
691 struct window *w;
692 struct glyph_row *row;
693 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
695 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
696 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
697 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
698 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
699 struct face *face = p->face;
700 int rowY;
702 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
703 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
704 if (p->y < rowY)
706 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
707 visible last row. */
708 int oldY = row->y;
709 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
710 row->visible_height = p->h;
711 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
712 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
713 row->y = oldY;
714 row->visible_height = oldVH;
716 else
717 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
719 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
721 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
722 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
723 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
724 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
725 if (face->stipple)
726 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
727 else
728 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
730 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
731 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
733 if (!face->stipple)
734 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
737 if (p->which)
739 unsigned char *bits;
740 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
741 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
742 XGCValues gcv;
744 if (p->wd > 8)
745 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
746 else
747 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
749 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
750 by the server. */
751 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
752 (p->cursor_p
753 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
754 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
755 : face->foreground),
756 face->background, depth);
758 if (p->overlay_p)
760 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
761 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
762 bits, p->wd, p->h,
763 1, 0, 1);
764 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
765 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
766 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
767 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
770 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
771 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
772 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
774 if (p->overlay_p)
776 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
777 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
778 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
782 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
787 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
788 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
789 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
790 rarely happens). */
792 static void
793 XTset_terminal_modes ()
797 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
798 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
800 static void
801 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
807 /***********************************************************************
808 Display Iterator
809 ***********************************************************************/
811 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
813 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
816 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
817 is not contained in the font. */
819 static XCharStruct *
820 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
821 XFontStruct *font;
822 XChar2b *char2b;
823 int font_type; /* unused on X */
825 /* The result metric information. */
826 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
828 xassert (font && char2b);
830 if (font->per_char != NULL)
832 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
834 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
835 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
836 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
837 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
838 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
839 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
840 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
841 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
842 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
843 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
845 else
847 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
848 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
849 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
850 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
852 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
853 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
855 where:
857 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
858 / = integer division
859 \ = integer modulus */
860 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
861 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
862 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
863 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
865 pcm = (font->per_char
866 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
867 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
868 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
872 else
874 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
875 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
876 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
877 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
878 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
879 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
882 return ((pcm == NULL
883 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
884 ? NULL : pcm);
888 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
889 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
891 static int
892 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
893 int c;
894 XChar2b *char2b;
895 struct font_info *font_info;
896 int *two_byte_p;
898 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
899 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
901 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
902 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
903 fixed encoding. */
904 if (font_info->font_encoder)
906 /* It's a program. */
907 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
909 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
911 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
912 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
913 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
915 else
917 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
918 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
919 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
922 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
924 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
925 program. */
926 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
927 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
928 else
929 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
931 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
933 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
934 encoding numbers. */
935 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
937 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
938 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
939 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
941 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
942 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
945 if (two_byte_p)
946 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
948 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
953 /***********************************************************************
954 Glyph display
955 ***********************************************************************/
959 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
960 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
961 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
962 int));
963 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
964 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
965 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
968 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
970 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
971 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
972 unsigned long *, double, int));
973 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
974 double, int, unsigned long));
975 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
976 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
977 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
978 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
979 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
980 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
981 int, int, int));
982 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
983 int, int, int, int, int, int,
984 XRectangle *));
985 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
986 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
988 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
989 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
990 #endif
993 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
994 face. */
996 static void
997 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
998 struct glyph_string *s;
1000 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
1001 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1002 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
1003 && !s->cmp)
1004 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
1005 else
1007 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
1008 XGCValues xgcv;
1009 unsigned long mask;
1011 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1012 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1014 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1015 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1016 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1017 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1018 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1019 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1020 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1022 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1023 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1024 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1026 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1027 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1030 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1031 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1032 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1033 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1035 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1036 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1037 mask, &xgcv);
1038 else
1039 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1040 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1042 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1047 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1049 static void
1050 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1051 struct glyph_string *s;
1053 int face_id;
1054 struct face *face;
1056 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1057 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1058 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1059 if (face == NULL)
1060 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1062 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1063 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1064 else
1065 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1066 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1067 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1069 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1070 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1071 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1072 else
1074 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1075 but font FONT. */
1076 XGCValues xgcv;
1077 unsigned long mask;
1079 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1080 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1081 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1082 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1083 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1084 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1086 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1087 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1088 mask, &xgcv);
1089 else
1090 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1091 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1093 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1096 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1100 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1101 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1102 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1104 static INLINE void
1105 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1106 struct glyph_string *s;
1108 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1112 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1113 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1114 pattern. */
1116 static INLINE void
1117 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1118 struct glyph_string *s;
1120 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1122 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1124 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1125 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1127 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1129 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1132 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1134 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1135 s->stippled_p = 0;
1137 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1139 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1140 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1142 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1143 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1145 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1146 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1148 else
1150 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1151 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1154 /* GC must have been set. */
1155 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1159 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1160 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1162 static INLINE void
1163 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1164 struct glyph_string *s;
1166 XRectangle r;
1167 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1168 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1172 /* RIF:
1173 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1174 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1176 static void
1177 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1178 struct glyph_string *s;
1180 if (s->cmp == NULL
1181 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1183 XCharStruct cs;
1184 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1185 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1186 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1187 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1188 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1193 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1195 static INLINE void
1196 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1197 struct glyph_string *s;
1198 int x, y, w, h;
1200 XGCValues xgcv;
1201 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1202 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1203 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1204 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1208 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1209 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1210 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1211 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1212 contains the first component of a composition. */
1214 static void
1215 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1216 struct glyph_string *s;
1217 int force_p;
1219 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1220 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1221 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1223 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1225 if (s->stippled_p)
1227 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1228 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1229 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1230 s->y + box_line_width,
1231 s->background_width,
1232 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1233 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1234 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1236 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1237 || s->font_not_found_p
1238 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1239 || force_p)
1241 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1242 s->background_width,
1243 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1244 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1250 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1252 static void
1253 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1254 struct glyph_string *s;
1256 int i, x;
1258 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1259 of S to the right of that box line. */
1260 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1261 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1262 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1263 else
1264 x = s->x;
1266 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1267 loaded. */
1268 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1270 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1272 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1273 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1274 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1275 s->height - 1);
1276 x += g->pixel_width;
1279 else
1281 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1282 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1284 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1285 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1287 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1288 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1289 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1290 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1292 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1293 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1294 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1295 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1296 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1297 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1298 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1300 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1301 if (s->two_byte_p)
1302 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1303 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1304 else
1305 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1306 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1308 else
1310 if (s->two_byte_p)
1311 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1312 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1313 else
1314 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1315 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1318 if (s->face->overstrike)
1320 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1321 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1322 if (s->two_byte_p)
1323 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1324 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1325 else
1326 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1327 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1332 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1334 static void
1335 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1336 struct glyph_string *s;
1338 int i, x;
1340 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1341 of S to the right of that box line. */
1342 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1343 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1344 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1345 else
1346 x = s->x;
1348 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1349 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1350 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1351 this composition. */
1353 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1354 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1355 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1357 if (s->gidx == 0)
1358 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1359 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1361 else
1363 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1365 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1366 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1367 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1368 s->char2b + i, 1);
1369 if (s->face->overstrike)
1370 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1371 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1372 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1373 s->char2b + i, 1);
1379 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1381 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1382 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1383 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1384 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1385 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1388 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1389 cannot be determined. */
1391 static struct frame *
1392 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1393 Widget widget;
1395 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1396 Lisp_Object tail;
1397 struct frame *f;
1399 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1401 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1402 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1403 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1404 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1405 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1406 widget = XtParent (widget);
1408 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1409 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1410 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1411 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1412 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1413 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1414 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1415 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1416 return f;
1418 abort ();
1422 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1423 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1424 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1425 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1428 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1429 Widget widget;
1430 Colormap cmap;
1431 XColor *color;
1433 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1434 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1438 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1439 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1440 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1441 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1442 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1443 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1446 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1447 Widget widget;
1448 Display *display;
1449 Colormap cmap;
1450 unsigned long *pixel;
1451 double factor;
1452 int delta;
1454 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1455 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1459 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1460 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1462 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1464 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1465 sizeof (Screen *)},
1466 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1467 sizeof (Colormap)}
1471 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1472 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1474 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1477 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1479 DPY is the display we are working on.
1481 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1482 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1483 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1484 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1486 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1487 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1489 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1490 we allocated the color or not.
1492 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1494 static Boolean
1495 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1496 Display *dpy;
1497 XrmValue *args;
1498 Cardinal *nargs;
1499 XrmValue *from, *to;
1500 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1502 Screen *screen;
1503 Colormap cmap;
1504 Pixel pixel;
1505 String color_name;
1506 XColor color;
1508 if (*nargs != 2)
1510 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1511 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1512 "XtToolkitError",
1513 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1514 return False;
1517 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1518 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1519 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1521 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1523 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1524 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1526 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1531 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1532 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1534 pixel = color.pixel;
1535 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1537 else
1539 String params[1];
1540 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1542 params[0] = color_name;
1543 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1544 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1545 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1546 params, &nparams);
1547 return False;
1550 if (to->addr != NULL)
1552 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1554 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1555 return False;
1558 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1560 else
1562 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1563 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1566 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1567 return True;
1571 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1572 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1573 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1575 APP is the application context in which we work.
1577 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1578 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1579 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1581 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1583 static void
1584 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1585 XtAppContext app;
1586 XrmValuePtr to;
1587 XtPointer closure;
1588 XrmValuePtr args;
1589 Cardinal *nargs;
1591 if (*nargs != 2)
1593 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1594 "XtToolkitError",
1595 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1596 NULL, NULL);
1598 else if (closure != NULL)
1600 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1601 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1602 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1603 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1604 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1609 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1612 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1613 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1614 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1615 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1617 static const XColor *
1618 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1619 Display *dpy;
1620 int *ncells;
1622 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1624 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1626 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1627 int i;
1629 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1630 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1631 dpyinfo->color_cells
1632 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1633 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1635 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1636 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1638 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1639 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1642 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1643 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1647 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1648 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1650 void
1651 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1652 struct frame *f;
1653 XColor *colors;
1654 int ncolors;
1656 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1658 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1660 int i;
1661 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1663 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1664 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1665 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1666 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1669 else
1670 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1674 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1675 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1677 void
1678 x_query_color (f, color)
1679 struct frame *f;
1680 XColor *color;
1682 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1686 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1687 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1688 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1689 allocated. */
1691 static int
1692 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1693 Display *dpy;
1694 Colormap cmap;
1695 XColor *color;
1697 int rc;
1699 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1700 if (rc == 0)
1702 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1703 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1704 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1705 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1706 int nearest, i;
1707 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1708 int ncells;
1709 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1711 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1713 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1714 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1715 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1716 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1718 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1720 nearest = i;
1721 nearest_delta = delta;
1725 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1726 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1727 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1728 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1730 else
1732 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1733 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1734 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1735 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1736 XColor *cached_color;
1738 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1739 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1740 (cached_color->red != color->red
1741 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1742 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1744 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1745 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1746 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1750 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1751 if (rc)
1752 register_color (color->pixel);
1753 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1755 return rc;
1759 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1760 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1761 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1762 allocated. */
1765 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1766 struct frame *f;
1767 Colormap cmap;
1768 XColor *color;
1770 gamma_correct (f, color);
1771 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1775 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1776 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1777 get color reference counts right. */
1779 unsigned long
1780 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1781 struct frame *f;
1782 unsigned long pixel;
1784 XColor color;
1786 color.pixel = pixel;
1787 BLOCK_INPUT;
1788 x_query_color (f, &color);
1789 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1791 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1792 register_color (pixel);
1793 #endif
1794 return color.pixel;
1798 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1799 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1800 get color reference counts right. */
1802 unsigned long
1803 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1804 Display *dpy;
1805 Colormap cmap;
1806 unsigned long pixel;
1808 XColor color;
1810 color.pixel = pixel;
1811 BLOCK_INPUT;
1812 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1813 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1814 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1815 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1816 register_color (pixel);
1817 #endif
1818 return color.pixel;
1822 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1823 boosted.
1825 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1826 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1827 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1828 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1829 use an additional additive factor.
1831 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1832 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1833 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1836 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1837 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1838 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1839 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1840 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1841 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1843 static int
1844 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1845 struct frame *f;
1846 Display *display;
1847 Colormap cmap;
1848 unsigned long *pixel;
1849 double factor;
1850 int delta;
1852 XColor color, new;
1853 long bright;
1854 int success_p;
1856 /* Get RGB color values. */
1857 color.pixel = *pixel;
1858 x_query_color (f, &color);
1860 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1861 xassert (factor >= 0);
1862 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1863 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1864 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1866 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1867 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1869 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1870 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1871 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1872 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1873 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1875 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1876 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1877 /* The additive adjustment. */
1878 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1880 if (factor < 1)
1882 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1883 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1884 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1886 else
1888 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1889 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1890 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1894 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1895 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1896 if (success_p)
1898 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1900 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1901 delta to the RGB values. */
1902 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1904 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1905 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1906 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1907 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1909 else
1910 success_p = 1;
1911 *pixel = new.pixel;
1914 return success_p;
1918 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1919 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1920 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1921 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1922 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1923 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1925 static void
1926 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1927 struct frame *f;
1928 struct relief *relief;
1929 double factor;
1930 int delta;
1931 unsigned long default_pixel;
1933 XGCValues xgcv;
1934 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1935 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1936 unsigned long pixel;
1937 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1938 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1939 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1940 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1942 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1943 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1945 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1946 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1947 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1948 if (relief->gc
1949 && relief->allocated_p)
1951 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1952 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1955 /* Allocate new color. */
1956 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1957 pixel = background;
1958 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1959 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1961 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1962 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1965 if (relief->gc == 0)
1967 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1968 mask |= GCStipple;
1969 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1971 else
1972 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1976 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1978 static void
1979 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1980 struct glyph_string *s;
1982 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1983 unsigned long color;
1985 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1986 color = s->face->box_color;
1987 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1988 && s->img->pixmap
1989 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1990 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1991 else
1993 XGCValues xgcv;
1995 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1996 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1997 color = xgcv.background;
2000 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2001 || color != di->relief_background)
2003 di->relief_background = color;
2004 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2005 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2006 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2007 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2012 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2013 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2014 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2015 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2016 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2017 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2018 when drawing. */
2020 static void
2021 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2022 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2023 struct frame *f;
2024 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2025 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2026 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2028 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2029 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2030 int i;
2031 GC gc;
2033 if (raised_p)
2034 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2035 else
2036 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2037 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2039 /* Top. */
2040 if (top_p)
2041 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2042 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2043 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2044 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2046 /* Left. */
2047 if (left_p)
2048 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2052 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2053 if (raised_p)
2054 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2055 else
2056 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2057 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2059 /* Bottom. */
2060 if (bot_p)
2061 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2062 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2063 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2064 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2066 /* Right. */
2067 if (right_p)
2068 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2069 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2070 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2072 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2076 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2077 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2078 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2079 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2080 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2081 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2083 static void
2084 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2085 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2086 struct glyph_string *s;
2087 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2088 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2090 XGCValues xgcv;
2092 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2093 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2094 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2096 /* Top. */
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2100 /* Left. */
2101 if (left_p)
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2105 /* Bottom. */
2106 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2107 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2109 /* Right. */
2110 if (right_p)
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2114 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2115 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2119 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2121 static void
2122 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2123 struct glyph_string *s;
2125 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2126 int left_p, right_p;
2127 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2128 XRectangle clip_rect;
2130 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
2131 if (s->row->full_width_p
2132 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2134 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (s->w);
2135 if (s->area != RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
2136 || WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (s->w))
2137 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->w);
2140 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2141 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2142 ? s->first_glyph
2143 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2145 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2146 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2147 left_x = s->x;
2148 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2149 ? last_x - 1
2150 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2151 top_y = s->y;
2152 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2154 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2155 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2156 && (s->prev == NULL
2157 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2158 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2159 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2160 && (s->next == NULL
2161 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2163 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2165 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2166 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2167 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2168 else
2170 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2171 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2172 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2177 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2179 static void
2180 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2181 struct glyph_string *s;
2183 int x = s->x;
2184 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2186 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2187 right of that line. */
2188 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2189 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2190 && s->slice.x == 0)
2191 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2193 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2194 by that margin. */
2195 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2196 x += s->img->hmargin;
2197 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2198 y += s->img->vmargin;
2200 if (s->img->pixmap)
2202 if (s->img->mask)
2204 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2205 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2206 trust on the shape extension to be available
2207 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2208 manually. */
2209 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2210 | GCFunction);
2211 XGCValues xgcv;
2212 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2214 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2215 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2216 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2217 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2218 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2220 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2221 image_rect.x = x;
2222 image_rect.y = y;
2223 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2224 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2225 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2226 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2227 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2228 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2230 else
2232 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2234 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2235 image_rect.x = x;
2236 image_rect.y = y;
2237 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2238 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2239 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2240 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2241 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2242 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2244 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2245 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2246 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2247 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2248 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2249 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2250 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2252 int r = s->img->relief;
2253 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2254 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2255 x - r, y - r,
2256 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2257 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2261 else
2262 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2263 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2264 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2268 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2270 static void
2271 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2272 struct glyph_string *s;
2274 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2275 XRectangle r;
2276 int x = s->x;
2277 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2279 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2280 right of that line. */
2281 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2282 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2283 && s->slice.x == 0)
2284 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2286 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2287 by that margin. */
2288 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2289 x += s->img->hmargin;
2290 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2291 y += s->img->vmargin;
2293 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2294 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2296 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2297 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2299 else
2301 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2302 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2305 x0 = x - thick;
2306 y0 = y - thick;
2307 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2308 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2310 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2311 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2312 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2313 s->slice.y == 0,
2314 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2315 s->slice.x == 0,
2316 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2317 &r);
2321 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2323 static void
2324 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2325 struct glyph_string *s;
2326 Pixmap pixmap;
2328 int x = 0;
2329 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2331 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2332 right of that line. */
2333 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2334 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2335 && s->slice.x == 0)
2336 x += abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2338 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2339 by that margin. */
2340 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2341 x += s->img->hmargin;
2342 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2343 y += s->img->vmargin;
2345 if (s->img->pixmap)
2347 if (s->img->mask)
2349 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2350 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2351 trust on the shape extension to be available
2352 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2353 manually. */
2354 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2355 | GCFunction);
2356 XGCValues xgcv;
2358 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2359 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2360 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2361 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2362 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2364 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2365 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2366 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2367 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2369 else
2371 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2372 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2373 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2375 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2376 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2377 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2378 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2379 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2380 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2381 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2383 int r = s->img->relief;
2384 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2385 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2386 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2387 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2391 else
2392 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2393 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2394 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2398 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2399 give the rectangle to draw. */
2401 static void
2402 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2403 struct glyph_string *s;
2404 int x, y, w, h;
2406 if (s->stippled_p)
2408 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2409 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2410 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2411 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2413 else
2414 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2418 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2420 s->y
2421 s->x +-------------------------
2422 | s->face->box
2424 | +-------------------------
2425 | | s->img->margin
2427 | | +-------------------
2428 | | | the image
2432 static void
2433 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2434 struct glyph_string *s;
2436 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2437 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2438 int height;
2439 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2441 height = s->height;
2442 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2443 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2444 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2445 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2447 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2448 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2449 flickering. */
2450 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2451 if (height > s->slice.height
2452 || s->img->hmargin
2453 || s->img->vmargin
2454 || s->img->mask
2455 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2456 || s->width != s->background_width)
2458 if (s->img->mask)
2460 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2461 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2462 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2463 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2464 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2466 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2467 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2468 s->background_width,
2469 s->height, depth);
2471 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2472 pixmap. */
2473 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2475 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2476 if (s->stippled_p)
2478 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2479 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2480 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2481 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2482 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2484 else
2486 XGCValues xgcv;
2487 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2488 &xgcv);
2489 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2490 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2491 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2492 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2495 else
2497 int x = s->x;
2498 int y = s->y;
2500 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2501 && s->slice.x == 0)
2502 x += box_line_hwidth;
2504 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2505 y += box_line_vwidth;
2507 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2510 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2513 /* Draw the foreground. */
2514 if (pixmap != None)
2516 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2517 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2518 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2519 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2520 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2522 else
2523 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2525 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2526 if (s->img->relief
2527 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2528 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2529 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2533 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2535 static void
2536 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2537 struct glyph_string *s;
2539 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2540 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2542 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2543 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2545 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2546 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2547 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2549 /* Draw cursor. */
2550 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2552 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2553 if (width < s->background_width)
2555 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2556 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2557 XRectangle r;
2558 GC gc;
2560 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2561 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2563 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2564 gc = s->gc;
2566 else
2567 gc = s->face->gc;
2569 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2570 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2572 if (s->face->stipple)
2574 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2575 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2576 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2577 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2579 else
2581 XGCValues xgcv;
2582 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2583 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2584 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2585 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2589 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2590 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2591 s->height);
2593 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2597 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2599 static void
2600 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2601 struct glyph_string *s;
2603 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2605 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2606 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2607 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2608 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2610 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2611 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2612 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2613 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2616 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2617 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2619 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2620 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2621 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2622 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2623 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2624 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2627 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2628 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2629 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2630 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2631 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2633 else
2634 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2636 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2638 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2639 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2640 break;
2642 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2643 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2644 break;
2646 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2647 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2648 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2649 else
2650 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2651 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2652 break;
2654 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2655 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2656 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2657 else
2658 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2659 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2660 break;
2662 default:
2663 abort ();
2666 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2668 /* Draw underline. */
2669 if (s->face->underline_p)
2671 unsigned long tem, h;
2672 int y;
2674 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2675 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2676 h = 1;
2678 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2679 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2680 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2681 specs, and its default is
2683 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2684 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2686 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2687 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2688 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2689 else if (s->face->font)
2690 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2691 else
2692 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2694 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2695 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2696 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2697 else
2699 XGCValues xgcv;
2700 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2701 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2702 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2703 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2704 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2708 /* Draw overline. */
2709 if (s->face->overline_p)
2711 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2713 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2714 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2715 s->width, h);
2716 else
2718 XGCValues xgcv;
2719 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2720 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2721 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2722 s->width, h);
2723 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2727 /* Draw strike-through. */
2728 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2730 unsigned long h = 1;
2731 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2733 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2734 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2735 s->width, h);
2736 else
2738 XGCValues xgcv;
2739 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2740 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2741 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2742 s->width, h);
2743 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2747 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2748 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2749 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2752 /* Reset clipping. */
2753 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2756 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2758 void
2759 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2760 struct frame *f;
2761 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2763 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2764 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2765 x, y, width, height,
2766 x + shift_by, y);
2769 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2770 for X frames. */
2772 static void
2773 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2774 register int n;
2776 abort ();
2780 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2781 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2783 void
2784 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2785 Display *dpy;
2786 Window window;
2787 int x, y;
2788 int width, height;
2789 int exposures;
2791 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2792 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2796 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2797 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2799 static void
2800 x_clear_frame ()
2802 struct frame *f;
2804 if (updating_frame)
2805 f = updating_frame;
2806 else
2807 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2809 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2810 longer visible. */
2811 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2812 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2813 output_cursor.x = -1;
2815 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2816 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2817 BLOCK_INPUT;
2818 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2820 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2821 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2822 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2824 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2826 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2831 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2833 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2834 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2836 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2839 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2840 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2842 static int
2843 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2844 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2846 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2847 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2848 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2850 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2851 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2852 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2855 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2857 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2858 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2859 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2862 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2863 positive. */
2864 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2865 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2867 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2868 negative. */
2869 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2872 void
2873 XTflash (f)
2874 struct frame *f;
2876 BLOCK_INPUT;
2879 GC gc;
2881 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2882 pixels into background pixels. */
2884 XGCValues values;
2886 values.function = GXxor;
2887 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2888 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2890 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2891 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2895 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2896 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2897 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2898 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2899 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2900 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2901 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2903 int width;
2905 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2906 edge it is next to. */
2907 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2909 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2910 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2911 break;
2913 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2914 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2915 break;
2917 default:
2918 break;
2921 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2923 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2924 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2926 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2927 flash_left,
2928 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2929 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2930 width, flash_height);
2931 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2932 flash_left,
2933 (height - flash_height
2934 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2935 width, flash_height);
2937 else
2938 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2939 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2940 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2941 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2943 x_flush (f);
2946 struct timeval wakeup;
2948 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2950 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2951 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2952 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2953 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2955 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2956 available. */
2957 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2959 struct timeval current;
2960 struct timeval timeout;
2962 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2964 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2965 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2966 break;
2968 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2969 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2970 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2972 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2973 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2977 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2978 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2980 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2981 flash_left,
2982 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2983 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2984 width, flash_height);
2985 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2986 flash_left,
2987 (height - flash_height
2988 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2989 width, flash_height);
2991 else
2992 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2993 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2994 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2995 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2997 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2998 x_flush (f);
3002 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3005 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3008 /* Make audible bell. */
3010 void
3011 XTring_bell ()
3013 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3015 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3017 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3018 if (visible_bell)
3019 XTflash (f);
3020 else
3021 #endif
3023 BLOCK_INPUT;
3024 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3025 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3026 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3032 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3033 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3034 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3035 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3037 static void
3038 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3039 register int n;
3041 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3046 /***********************************************************************
3047 Line Dance
3048 ***********************************************************************/
3050 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3051 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3053 static void
3054 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3055 int vpos, n;
3057 abort ();
3061 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3063 static void
3064 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3065 struct window *w;
3066 struct run *run;
3068 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3069 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3071 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3072 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3073 fringe of W. */
3074 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3076 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3077 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3078 bottom_y = y + height;
3080 if (to_y < from_y)
3082 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3083 line at the bottom. */
3084 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3085 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3086 else
3087 height = run->height;
3089 else
3091 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3092 at the bottom. */
3093 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3094 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3095 else
3096 height = run->height;
3099 BLOCK_INPUT;
3101 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3102 updated_window = w;
3103 x_clear_cursor (w);
3105 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3106 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3107 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3108 x, from_y,
3109 width, height,
3110 x, to_y);
3112 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3117 /***********************************************************************
3118 Exposure Events
3119 ***********************************************************************/
3122 static void
3123 frame_highlight (f)
3124 struct frame *f;
3126 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3127 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3128 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3129 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3130 BLOCK_INPUT;
3131 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3132 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3133 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3134 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3137 static void
3138 frame_unhighlight (f)
3139 struct frame *f;
3141 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3142 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3143 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3144 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3145 BLOCK_INPUT;
3146 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3147 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3148 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3149 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3152 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3153 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3154 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3155 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3156 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3158 static void
3159 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3160 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3161 struct frame *frame;
3163 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3165 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3167 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3168 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3169 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3171 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3172 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3174 #if 0
3175 selected_frame = frame;
3176 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3177 selected_frame);
3178 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3179 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3180 #endif /* ! 0 */
3182 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3183 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3184 else
3185 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3188 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3191 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3192 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3193 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3195 static void
3196 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3197 int type;
3198 int state;
3199 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3200 struct frame *frame;
3201 struct input_event *bufp;
3203 if (type == FocusIn)
3205 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3207 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3208 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3210 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3211 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3212 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3213 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3214 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3216 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3217 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3221 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3223 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3224 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3225 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3226 #endif
3228 else if (type == FocusOut)
3230 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3232 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3234 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3235 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3238 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3239 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3240 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3241 #endif
3245 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3246 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3248 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3250 static void
3251 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3252 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3253 XEvent *event;
3254 struct input_event *bufp;
3256 struct frame *frame;
3258 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3259 if (! frame)
3260 return;
3262 switch (event->type)
3264 case EnterNotify:
3265 case LeaveNotify:
3267 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3268 int focus_state
3269 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3271 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3272 && event->xcrossing.focus
3273 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3274 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3275 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3276 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3278 break;
3280 case FocusIn:
3281 case FocusOut:
3282 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3283 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3284 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3285 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3286 break;
3291 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3293 void
3294 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3295 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3297 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3300 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3301 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3302 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3304 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3305 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3306 the appropriate X display info. */
3308 static void
3309 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3310 struct frame *frame;
3312 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3315 static void
3316 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3317 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3319 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3321 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3323 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3324 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3325 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3326 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3327 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3329 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3330 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3333 else
3334 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3336 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3338 if (old_highlight)
3339 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3340 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3341 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3347 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3349 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3350 static void
3351 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3352 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3354 int min_code, max_code;
3355 KeySym *syms;
3356 int syms_per_code;
3357 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3359 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3360 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3361 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3362 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3363 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3365 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3366 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3367 #else
3368 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3369 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3370 #endif
3372 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3373 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3374 &syms_per_code);
3375 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3377 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3378 Alt keysyms are on. */
3380 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3381 int found_alt_or_meta;
3383 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3385 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3386 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3388 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3390 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3391 if (code == 0)
3392 continue;
3394 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3396 int code_col;
3398 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3400 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3402 switch (sym)
3404 case XK_Meta_L:
3405 case XK_Meta_R:
3406 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3407 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3408 break;
3410 case XK_Alt_L:
3411 case XK_Alt_R:
3412 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3413 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3414 break;
3416 case XK_Hyper_L:
3417 case XK_Hyper_R:
3418 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3419 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3420 code_col = syms_per_code;
3421 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3422 break;
3424 case XK_Super_L:
3425 case XK_Super_R:
3426 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3427 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3428 code_col = syms_per_code;
3429 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3430 break;
3432 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3433 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3434 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3435 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3436 code_col = syms_per_code;
3437 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3438 break;
3446 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3447 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3449 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3450 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3453 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3454 make them just meta, not alt. */
3455 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3457 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3460 XFree ((char *) syms);
3461 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3464 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3465 Emacs uses. */
3467 static unsigned int
3468 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3469 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3470 unsigned int state;
3472 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3473 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3474 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3475 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3476 Lisp_Object tem;
3478 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3479 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3480 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3481 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3482 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3483 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3484 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3485 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3488 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3489 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3490 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3491 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3492 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3493 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3496 static unsigned int
3497 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3498 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3499 unsigned int state;
3501 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3502 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3503 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3504 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3506 Lisp_Object tem;
3508 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3509 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3510 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3511 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3512 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3513 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3514 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3515 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3518 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3519 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3520 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3521 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3522 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3523 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3526 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3528 char *
3529 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3530 KeySym keysym;
3532 char *value;
3534 BLOCK_INPUT;
3535 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3536 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3538 return value;
3543 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3545 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3547 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3548 the mouse. */
3550 static Lisp_Object
3551 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3552 struct input_event *result;
3553 XButtonEvent *event;
3554 struct frame *f;
3556 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3557 otherwise. */
3558 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3559 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3560 result->timestamp = event->time;
3561 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3562 event->state)
3563 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3564 ? up_modifier
3565 : down_modifier));
3567 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3568 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3569 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3570 result->arg = Qnil;
3571 return Qnil;
3575 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3576 The input handler calls this.
3578 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3579 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3580 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3581 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3583 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3584 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3586 static void
3587 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3588 FRAME_PTR frame;
3589 XMotionEvent *event;
3591 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3592 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3593 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3595 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3597 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3598 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3599 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3602 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3603 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3604 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3605 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3606 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3608 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3609 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3610 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3615 /************************************************************************
3616 Mouse Face
3617 ************************************************************************/
3619 static void
3620 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3622 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3623 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3624 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3625 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3626 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3630 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3633 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3634 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3635 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3636 values. */
3638 static int
3639 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3640 struct frame *f;
3641 int x, y;
3642 XRectangle *rect;
3644 Lisp_Object window;
3645 struct window *w;
3646 struct glyph_row *r, *end_row;
3648 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3649 if (NILP (window))
3650 return 0;
3652 w = XWINDOW (window);
3653 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3654 end_row = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3656 for (; r < end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3658 if (r->y >= y)
3660 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3661 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3662 int gx = r->x;
3663 while (g < end && gx < x)
3664 gx += g->pixel_width, ++g;
3665 if (g < end)
3667 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3668 rect->height = r->height;
3669 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3670 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3671 return 1;
3673 break;
3677 return 0;
3681 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3682 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3684 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3685 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3686 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3687 position on the scroll bar.
3689 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3690 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3691 the mouse is over.
3693 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3694 was at this position.
3696 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3698 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3699 movement. */
3701 static void
3702 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3703 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3704 int insist;
3705 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3706 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3707 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3708 unsigned long *time;
3710 FRAME_PTR f1;
3712 BLOCK_INPUT;
3714 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3715 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3716 else
3718 Window root;
3719 int root_x, root_y;
3721 Window dummy_window;
3722 int dummy;
3724 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3726 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3727 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3728 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3729 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3731 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3733 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3734 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3735 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3737 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3738 &root,
3740 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3741 a different screen. */
3742 &dummy_window,
3744 /* The position on that root window. */
3745 &root_x, &root_y,
3747 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3748 &dummy, &dummy,
3750 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3751 we don't care. */
3752 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3754 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3755 containing the pointer. */
3757 Window win, child;
3758 int win_x, win_y;
3759 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3760 int count;
3762 win = root;
3764 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3765 structure is changing at the same time this function
3766 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3768 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3770 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3771 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3773 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3774 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3775 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3777 /* From-window, to-window. */
3778 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3780 /* From-position, to-position. */
3781 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3783 /* Child of win. */
3784 &child);
3785 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3787 else
3789 while (1)
3791 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3793 /* From-window, to-window. */
3794 root, win,
3796 /* From-position, to-position. */
3797 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3799 /* Child of win. */
3800 &child);
3802 if (child == None || child == win)
3803 break;
3805 win = child;
3806 parent_x = win_x;
3807 parent_y = win_y;
3810 /* Now we know that:
3811 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3812 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3813 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3814 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3815 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3816 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3817 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3818 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3819 never use them in that case.) */
3821 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3822 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3824 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3825 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3826 on the frame. */
3827 if (f1 != NULL
3828 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3829 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3830 f1 = NULL;
3831 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3834 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3835 f1 = 0;
3837 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3839 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3840 if (! f1)
3842 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3844 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3846 if (bar)
3848 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3849 win_x = parent_x;
3850 win_y = parent_y;
3854 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3855 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3857 if (f1)
3859 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3860 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3861 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3862 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3863 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3864 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3865 the frame are divided into. */
3867 int width, height, gx, gy;
3868 XRectangle rect;
3870 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3871 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3872 else
3874 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3875 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3876 gx = win_x;
3877 gy = win_y;
3879 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3880 round down even for negative values. */
3881 if (gx < 0)
3882 gx -= width - 1;
3883 if (gy < 0)
3884 gy -= height - 1;
3885 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3886 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3888 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3889 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3890 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3891 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3894 *bar_window = Qnil;
3895 *part = 0;
3896 *fp = f1;
3897 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3898 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3899 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3904 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3909 /***********************************************************************
3910 Scroll bars
3911 ***********************************************************************/
3913 /* Scroll bar support. */
3915 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3916 manages it.
3917 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3918 bits. */
3920 static struct scroll_bar *
3921 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3922 Display *display;
3923 Window window_id;
3925 Lisp_Object tail;
3927 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3928 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3929 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
3931 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3932 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3933 tail = XCDR (tail))
3935 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3937 frame = XCAR (tail);
3938 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3939 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3940 abort ();
3942 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3943 right window ID. */
3944 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3945 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3946 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3947 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3948 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3949 condemned = Qnil,
3950 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3951 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3952 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3953 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3954 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3957 return 0;
3961 #if defined USE_LUCID
3963 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3964 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3966 static Widget
3967 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3968 Window window;
3970 Lisp_Object tail;
3972 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3973 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3974 tail = XCDR (tail))
3976 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3977 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3979 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3980 return menu_bar;
3983 return NULL;
3986 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3989 /************************************************************************
3990 Toolkit scroll bars
3991 ************************************************************************/
3993 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3995 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3996 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3997 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3998 struct scroll_bar *));
3999 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
4000 int, int, int));
4003 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4004 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4006 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4008 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4010 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4012 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4013 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4015 #ifndef USE_GTK
4016 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4018 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4020 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4022 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4023 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4024 to avoid jerkyness. */
4026 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4028 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
4030 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4031 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4032 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4033 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4035 static void
4036 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
4037 num_params)
4038 Widget widget;
4039 XtPointer client_data;
4040 String action_name;
4041 XEvent *event;
4042 String *params;
4043 Cardinal *num_params;
4045 int scroll_bar_p;
4046 char *end_action;
4048 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4049 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4050 end_action = "Release";
4051 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4052 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4053 end_action = "EndScroll";
4054 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4056 if (scroll_bar_p
4057 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4058 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4060 struct window *w;
4062 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4063 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4064 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4066 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4068 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4069 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4070 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4072 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4073 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4075 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4076 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4079 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4081 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4082 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4084 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4085 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4088 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4089 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4090 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4091 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4093 static void
4094 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4095 Lisp_Object window;
4096 int part, portion, whole;
4098 XEvent event;
4099 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4100 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4101 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4102 int i;
4104 BLOCK_INPUT;
4106 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4107 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4108 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4109 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4110 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4111 ev->format = 32;
4113 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4114 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4115 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4116 into that array in the event. */
4117 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4118 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4119 break;
4121 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4123 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4124 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4125 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4127 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4128 nbytes);
4129 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4130 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4133 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4134 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4135 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4136 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4137 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4138 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4140 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4141 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4143 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4144 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4145 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4146 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4151 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4152 in *IEVENT. */
4154 static void
4155 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4156 XEvent *event;
4157 struct input_event *ievent;
4159 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4160 Lisp_Object window;
4161 struct frame *f;
4162 struct window *w;
4164 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4165 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4167 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4168 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4170 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4171 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4172 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4173 #ifdef USE_GTK
4174 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4175 #else
4176 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4177 #endif
4178 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4179 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4180 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4181 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4182 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4186 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4188 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4190 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4193 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4194 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4195 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4197 static void
4198 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4199 Widget widget;
4200 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4202 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4203 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4204 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4206 switch (cs->reason)
4208 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4209 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4210 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4211 break;
4213 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4214 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4215 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4216 break;
4218 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4219 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4220 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4221 break;
4223 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4224 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4225 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4226 break;
4228 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4229 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4230 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4231 break;
4233 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4234 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4235 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4236 break;
4238 case XmCR_DRAG:
4240 int slider_size;
4242 /* Get the slider size. */
4243 BLOCK_INPUT;
4244 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4245 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4247 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4248 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4249 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4250 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4252 break;
4254 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4255 break;
4258 if (part >= 0)
4260 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4261 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4262 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4267 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4268 #ifdef USE_GTK
4269 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4270 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4272 static void
4273 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4274 GtkRange *widget;
4275 gpointer data;
4277 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4278 gdouble previous;
4279 gdouble position;
4280 gdouble *p;
4281 int diff;
4283 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4284 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4286 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4288 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4290 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4291 if (! p)
4293 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4294 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4295 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4298 previous = *p;
4299 *p = position;
4301 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4303 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4305 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4306 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4308 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4310 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4311 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4313 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4315 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4316 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4318 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4320 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4321 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4323 else
4325 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4326 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4327 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4328 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4331 if (part >= 0)
4333 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4334 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4335 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4339 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4341 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4342 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4343 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4344 the thumb is. */
4346 static void
4347 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4348 Widget widget;
4349 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4351 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4352 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4353 float shown;
4354 int whole, portion, height;
4355 int part;
4357 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4358 BLOCK_INPUT;
4359 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4360 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4362 whole = 10000000;
4363 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4365 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4366 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4367 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4368 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4369 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4370 bottom). */
4371 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4372 else
4373 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4375 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4376 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4377 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4378 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4382 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4383 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4384 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4385 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4386 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4387 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4388 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4390 static void
4391 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4392 Widget widget;
4393 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4395 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4396 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4397 int position = (long) call_data;
4398 Dimension height;
4399 int part;
4401 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4402 BLOCK_INPUT;
4403 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4404 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4406 if (abs (position) >= height)
4407 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4409 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4410 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4411 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4412 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4413 else
4414 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4416 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4417 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4418 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4419 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4422 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4423 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4425 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4427 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4428 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4430 #ifdef USE_GTK
4431 static void
4432 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4433 struct frame *f;
4434 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4436 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4438 BLOCK_INPUT;
4439 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4440 scroll_bar_name);
4441 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4444 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4446 static void
4447 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4448 struct frame *f;
4449 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4451 Window xwindow;
4452 Widget widget;
4453 Arg av[20];
4454 int ac = 0;
4455 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4456 unsigned long pixel;
4458 BLOCK_INPUT;
4460 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4461 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4462 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4463 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4464 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4465 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4466 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4467 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4468 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4470 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4471 if (pixel != -1)
4473 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4474 ++ac;
4477 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4478 if (pixel != -1)
4480 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4481 ++ac;
4484 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4485 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4487 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4488 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4489 (XtPointer) bar);
4490 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4491 (XtPointer) bar);
4492 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4493 (XtPointer) bar);
4494 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4495 (XtPointer) bar);
4496 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4497 (XtPointer) bar);
4498 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4499 (XtPointer) bar);
4500 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4501 (XtPointer) bar);
4503 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4504 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4506 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4507 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4508 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4509 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4511 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4513 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4514 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4515 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4516 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4517 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4518 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4519 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4520 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4522 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4523 if (pixel != -1)
4525 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4526 ++ac;
4529 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4530 if (pixel != -1)
4532 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4533 ++ac;
4536 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4538 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4539 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4541 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4542 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4543 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4544 pixel = -1;
4545 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4547 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4549 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4550 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4551 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4552 pixel = -1;
4553 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4556 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4557 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4558 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4559 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4560 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4562 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4563 ++ac;
4565 else
4566 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4567 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4568 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4570 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4571 the shadows. */
4572 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4573 ++ac;
4575 /* Specify the colors. */
4576 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4577 if (pixel != -1)
4579 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
4580 ++ac;
4582 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4583 if (pixel != -1)
4585 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
4586 ++ac;
4590 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4591 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4594 char *initial = "";
4595 char *val = initial;
4596 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4597 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4598 if (val == initial)
4599 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4600 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4601 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
4602 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4606 /* Define callbacks. */
4607 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4608 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4609 (XtPointer) bar);
4611 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4612 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4614 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4616 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4617 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4618 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4619 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4621 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4622 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4623 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4624 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4626 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4628 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4631 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4632 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4634 #ifdef USE_GTK
4635 static void
4636 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4637 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4638 int portion, position, whole;
4640 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4643 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4644 static void
4645 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4646 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4647 int portion, position, whole;
4649 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4650 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4651 float top, shown;
4653 BLOCK_INPUT;
4655 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4657 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4658 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4659 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4660 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4661 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4662 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4663 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4664 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4665 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4666 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4667 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4668 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4669 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4670 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4671 whole += portion;
4673 if (whole <= 0)
4674 top = 0, shown = 1;
4675 else
4677 top = (float) position / whole;
4678 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4681 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4683 int size, value;
4685 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4686 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4687 value. */
4688 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4689 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4690 size = max (size, 1);
4692 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4693 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4694 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4696 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4698 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4700 if (whole == 0)
4701 top = 0, shown = 1;
4702 else
4704 top = (float) position / whole;
4705 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4709 float old_top, old_shown;
4710 Dimension height;
4711 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4712 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4713 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4714 XtNheight, &height,
4715 NULL);
4717 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4718 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4719 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4720 else
4721 top = old_top;
4722 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4723 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4725 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4726 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4727 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4728 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4730 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4731 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4732 else
4734 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4735 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
4736 int scroll_mode = 0;
4738 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
4739 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
4741 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
4742 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
4743 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
4744 if (scroll_mode == 2)
4745 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
4747 #endif
4748 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4749 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4750 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4752 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4754 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4755 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
4756 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
4757 #endif
4761 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4763 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4765 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4767 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4771 /************************************************************************
4772 Scroll bars, general
4773 ************************************************************************/
4775 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4776 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4777 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4778 scroll bar. */
4780 static struct scroll_bar *
4781 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4782 struct window *w;
4783 int top, left, width, height;
4785 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4786 struct scroll_bar *bar
4787 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4789 BLOCK_INPUT;
4791 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4792 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4793 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4795 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4796 unsigned long mask;
4797 Window window;
4799 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4800 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4801 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4803 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4804 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4805 | ExposureMask);
4806 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4808 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4810 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4811 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4812 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4813 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4814 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4815 left, top, width,
4816 window_box_height (w), False);
4818 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4819 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4820 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4821 top,
4822 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4823 height,
4824 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4826 CopyFromParent,
4827 CopyFromParent,
4828 CopyFromParent,
4829 /* Attributes. */
4830 mask, &a);
4831 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4833 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4835 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4836 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4837 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4838 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4839 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4840 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4841 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4842 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4844 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4845 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4846 bar->prev = Qnil;
4847 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4848 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4849 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4851 /* Map the window/widget. */
4852 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4854 #ifdef USE_GTK
4855 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4856 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4857 top,
4858 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4859 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4860 max (height, 1));
4861 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4862 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4863 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4864 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4865 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4866 top,
4867 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4868 max (height, 1), 0);
4869 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4870 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4872 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4873 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4874 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4876 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4877 return bar;
4881 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4883 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4884 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4885 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4886 events.)
4888 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4889 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4890 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4891 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4892 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4894 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4896 static void
4897 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4898 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4899 int start, end;
4900 int rebuild;
4902 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4903 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4904 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4905 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4907 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4908 if (! rebuild
4909 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4910 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4911 return;
4913 BLOCK_INPUT;
4916 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4917 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4918 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4920 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4921 the distance between start and end. */
4923 int length = end - start;
4925 if (start < 0)
4926 start = 0;
4927 else if (start > top_range)
4928 start = top_range;
4929 end = start + length;
4931 if (end < start)
4932 end = start;
4933 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4934 end = top_range;
4937 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4938 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4939 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4941 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4942 if (end > top_range)
4943 end = top_range;
4945 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4946 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4947 that many pixels tall. */
4948 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4950 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4951 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4952 if (0 < start)
4953 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4954 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4955 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4956 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4957 inside_width, start,
4958 False);
4960 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4961 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4962 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4963 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4965 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4966 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4967 /* x, y, width, height */
4968 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4969 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4970 inside_width, end - start);
4972 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4973 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4974 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4975 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4977 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4978 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4979 if (end < inside_height)
4980 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4981 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4982 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4983 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4984 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4985 False);
4989 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4992 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4994 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4995 nil. */
4997 static void
4998 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4999 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5001 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5002 BLOCK_INPUT;
5004 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5005 #ifdef USE_GTK
5006 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
5007 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5008 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5009 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5010 #else
5011 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
5012 #endif
5014 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5015 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5017 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5021 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5022 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5023 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5024 create one. */
5026 static void
5027 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
5028 struct window *w;
5029 int portion, whole, position;
5031 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5032 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5033 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5034 int window_y, window_height;
5036 /* Get window dimensions. */
5037 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5038 top = window_y;
5039 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5040 height = window_height;
5042 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5043 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5045 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5046 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5047 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5048 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5049 else
5050 sb_width = width;
5052 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5053 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5054 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5055 sb_left = (left +
5056 (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5057 ? width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2
5058 : 0));
5059 else
5060 sb_left = (left +
5061 (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5062 ? (width - sb_width) / 2
5063 : width - sb_width));
5064 #else
5065 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5066 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5067 else
5068 sb_left = left;
5069 #endif
5071 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5072 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5074 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5076 BLOCK_INPUT;
5077 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5078 left, top, width, height, False);
5079 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5082 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5084 else
5086 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5087 unsigned int mask = 0;
5089 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5091 BLOCK_INPUT;
5093 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5094 mask |= CWX;
5095 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5096 mask |= CWY;
5097 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5098 mask |= CWWidth;
5099 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5100 mask |= CWHeight;
5102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5104 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5105 if (mask)
5107 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5108 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5109 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5110 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5111 left, top, width, height, False);
5112 #ifdef USE_GTK
5113 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5114 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5115 top,
5116 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5117 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5118 max (height, 1));
5119 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5120 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5121 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5122 top,
5123 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5124 max (height, 1), 0);
5125 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5127 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5129 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5130 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5131 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5133 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5134 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5135 height, False);
5136 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5137 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5138 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5139 height, False);
5142 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5143 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5144 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5145 example. */
5147 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5148 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5149 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5151 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5152 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5153 left + area_width - rest, top,
5154 rest, height, False);
5155 else
5156 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5157 left, top, rest, height, False);
5161 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5162 if (mask)
5164 XWindowChanges wc;
5166 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5167 wc.y = top;
5168 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5169 wc.height = height;
5170 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5171 mask, &wc);
5174 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5176 /* Remember new settings. */
5177 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5178 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5179 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5180 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5182 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5185 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5186 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5187 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5188 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5189 dragged. */
5190 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5192 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5194 if (whole == 0)
5195 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5196 else
5198 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5199 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5200 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5203 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5205 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5209 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5210 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5211 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5212 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5213 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5214 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5215 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5217 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5218 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5219 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5221 static void
5222 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5223 FRAME_PTR frame;
5225 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5226 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5228 Lisp_Object bar;
5229 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5230 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5231 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5232 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5233 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5234 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5235 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5240 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5241 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5243 static void
5244 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5245 struct window *window;
5247 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5248 struct frame *f;
5250 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5251 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5252 abort ();
5254 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5256 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5257 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5258 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5260 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5261 the lists. */
5262 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5263 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5264 return;
5265 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5266 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5267 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5268 else
5269 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5270 one or the other! */
5271 abort ();
5273 else
5274 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5276 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5277 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5279 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5280 bar->prev = Qnil;
5281 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5282 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5283 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5286 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5287 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5289 static void
5290 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5291 FRAME_PTR f;
5293 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5295 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5297 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5298 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5299 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5301 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5303 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5305 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5307 next = b->next;
5308 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5311 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5312 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5316 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5317 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5318 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5320 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5321 mark bits. */
5323 static void
5324 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5325 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5326 XEvent *event;
5328 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5329 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5330 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5331 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5333 BLOCK_INPUT;
5335 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5337 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5338 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5340 /* x, y, width, height */
5341 0, 0,
5342 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5343 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5345 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5348 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5350 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5351 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5353 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5354 mark bits. */
5357 static void
5358 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5359 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5360 XEvent *event;
5361 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5363 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5364 abort ();
5366 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5367 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5368 emacs_event->modifiers
5369 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5370 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5371 event->xbutton.state)
5372 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5373 ? up_modifier
5374 : down_modifier));
5375 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5376 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5377 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5379 #if 0
5380 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5381 int internal_height
5382 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5383 #endif
5384 int top_range
5385 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5386 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5388 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5389 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5391 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5392 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5393 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5394 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5395 else
5396 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5398 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5399 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5400 whether or not we're dragging. */
5401 #if 0
5402 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5403 holding it. */
5404 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5405 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5406 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5407 #endif
5409 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5410 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5411 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5412 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5414 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5415 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5417 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5418 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5420 #endif
5422 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5423 #if 0
5424 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5425 the handle. */
5426 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5427 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5428 else
5429 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5430 #else
5431 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5432 #endif
5434 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5438 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5440 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5442 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5443 mark bits. */
5445 static void
5446 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5447 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5448 XEvent *event;
5450 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5452 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5454 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5455 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5457 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5458 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5460 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5461 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5463 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5465 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5467 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5472 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5474 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5475 on the scroll bar. */
5477 static void
5478 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5479 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5480 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5481 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5482 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5483 unsigned long *time;
5485 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5486 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5487 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5488 int win_x, win_y;
5489 Window dummy_window;
5490 int dummy_coord;
5491 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5493 BLOCK_INPUT;
5495 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5496 report that. */
5497 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5499 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5500 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5501 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5503 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5504 &win_x, &win_y,
5506 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5507 &dummy_mask))
5509 else
5511 #if 0
5512 int inside_height
5513 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5514 #endif
5515 int top_range
5516 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5518 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5520 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5521 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5523 if (win_y < 0)
5524 win_y = 0;
5525 if (win_y > top_range)
5526 win_y = top_range;
5528 *fp = f;
5529 *bar_window = bar->window;
5531 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5532 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5533 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5534 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5535 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5536 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5537 else
5538 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5540 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5541 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5543 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5544 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5547 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5549 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5553 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5554 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5555 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5556 redraw them. */
5558 void
5559 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5560 FRAME_PTR f;
5562 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5563 Lisp_Object bar;
5565 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5566 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5567 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5568 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5569 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5570 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5571 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5572 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5573 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5574 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5578 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5580 #if 0
5581 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5582 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5583 sometimes don't work. */
5585 static Time enter_timestamp;
5586 #endif
5588 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5589 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5590 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5591 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5593 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5594 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5596 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5598 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5599 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5601 static int temp_index;
5602 static short temp_buffer[100];
5604 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5605 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5606 temp_index = 0; \
5607 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5609 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5610 on a particular display. */
5612 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5614 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5615 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5616 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5617 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5619 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5621 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5622 do \
5624 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5625 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5626 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5627 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5628 inev.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5629 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f); \
5631 while (0)
5633 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5634 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5637 enum
5639 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5640 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5641 X_EVENT_DROP
5644 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5645 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5646 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5648 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5649 this event further.
5650 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5652 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5653 static int
5654 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5655 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5656 XEvent *event;
5658 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5659 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5660 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5661 was created. */
5663 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5664 event->xclient.window);
5666 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5668 #endif
5670 #ifdef USE_GTK
5671 static int current_count;
5672 static int current_finish;
5673 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5675 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5676 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5677 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5678 static GdkFilterReturn
5679 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5680 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5681 GdkEvent *ev;
5682 gpointer data;
5684 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5686 if (current_count >= 0)
5688 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5690 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5692 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5693 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5694 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5695 so we do it here. */
5696 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5697 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5698 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5699 #endif
5701 if (! dpyinfo)
5702 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5703 else
5705 current_count +=
5706 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5707 current_hold_quit);
5710 else
5711 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5713 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5714 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5716 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5718 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5721 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5723 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5724 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5725 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5727 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5729 static int
5730 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5731 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5732 XEvent *eventp;
5733 int *finish;
5734 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5736 struct input_event inev;
5737 int count = 0;
5738 int do_help = 0;
5739 int nbytes = 0;
5740 struct frame *f;
5741 struct coding_system coding;
5742 XEvent event = *eventp;
5744 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5746 EVENT_INIT (inev);
5747 inev.kind = NO_EVENT;
5748 inev.arg = Qnil;
5750 switch (event.type)
5752 case ClientMessage:
5754 if (event.xclient.message_type
5755 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5756 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5758 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5759 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5761 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5762 could be the shell widget window
5763 if the frame has no title bar. */
5764 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5765 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5766 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5767 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5768 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5769 #endif
5770 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5771 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5772 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5773 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5774 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5775 needed.
5777 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5778 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5779 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5780 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5781 Emacs. */
5783 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5784 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5785 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5786 if (f)
5788 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5789 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5790 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5791 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5792 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5793 /* The ICCCM says this is
5794 the only valid choice. */
5795 RevertToParent,
5796 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5797 /* This is needed to detect the error
5798 if there is an error. */
5799 XSync (d, False);
5800 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5802 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5803 #endif /* 0 */
5804 goto done;
5807 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5808 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5810 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5811 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5812 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5813 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5814 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5815 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5816 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5817 session manager and one for this. */
5818 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5819 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5820 #endif
5822 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5823 event.xclient.window);
5824 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5825 for a single Emacs process. */
5826 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5827 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5828 event.xclient.window,
5829 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5830 else if (f)
5831 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5832 event.xclient.window,
5833 0, 0);
5835 goto done;
5838 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5839 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5841 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5842 event.xclient.window);
5843 if (!f)
5844 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5846 inev.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5847 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
5848 goto done;
5851 goto done;
5854 if (event.xclient.message_type
5855 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5857 goto done;
5860 if (event.xclient.message_type
5861 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5863 int new_x, new_y;
5864 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5866 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5867 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5869 if (f)
5871 f->left_pos = new_x;
5872 f->top_pos = new_y;
5874 goto done;
5877 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5878 if (event.xclient.message_type
5879 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5881 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5882 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5883 &event, NULL);
5884 goto done;
5886 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5888 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5889 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5890 || (event.xclient.message_type
5891 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5893 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5894 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5895 currently never do because we are interested in
5896 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5897 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5898 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5899 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5900 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5901 goto done;
5904 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5905 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5906 we construct an input_event. */
5907 if (event.xclient.message_type
5908 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5910 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev);
5911 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5912 goto done;
5914 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5916 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5918 if (!f)
5919 goto OTHER;
5921 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev))
5922 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5924 break;
5926 case SelectionNotify:
5927 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5928 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5929 goto OTHER;
5930 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5931 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5932 break;
5934 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5935 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5936 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5937 goto OTHER;
5938 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5940 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5942 inev.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5943 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5944 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5945 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5946 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5948 break;
5950 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5951 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5952 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5953 goto OTHER;
5954 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5956 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5957 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5959 inev.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5960 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5961 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev) = eventp->requestor;
5962 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5963 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev) = eventp->target;
5964 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev) = eventp->property;
5965 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5966 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5968 break;
5970 case PropertyNotify:
5971 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5972 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5973 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
5974 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
5975 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
5976 goto OTHER;
5977 #endif
5978 #endif
5979 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
5980 goto OTHER;
5982 case ReparentNotify:
5983 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
5984 if (f)
5986 int x, y;
5987 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
5988 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
5989 f->left_pos = x;
5990 f->top_pos = y;
5992 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
5993 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
5995 goto OTHER;
5997 case Expose:
5998 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
5999 if (f)
6001 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6003 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6005 f->async_visible = 1;
6006 f->async_iconified = 0;
6007 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6008 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6010 else
6011 expose_frame (f,
6012 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6013 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6015 else
6017 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6018 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6019 #endif
6020 #if defined USE_LUCID
6021 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6022 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6023 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6025 Widget widget
6026 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6027 if (widget)
6028 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6030 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6032 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6033 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6034 goto OTHER;
6035 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6036 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6037 event.xexpose.window);
6039 if (bar)
6040 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6041 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6042 else
6043 goto OTHER;
6044 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6045 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6047 break;
6049 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6050 source area was obscured or not
6051 available. */
6052 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6053 if (f)
6055 expose_frame (f,
6056 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6057 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6058 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6060 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6061 else
6062 goto OTHER;
6063 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6064 break;
6066 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6067 source area was completely
6068 available. */
6069 break;
6071 case UnmapNotify:
6072 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6073 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6075 tip_window = 0;
6076 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6079 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6080 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6081 the frame was deleted. */
6083 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6084 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6085 display that won't ever be seen. */
6086 f->async_visible = 0;
6087 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6088 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6089 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6090 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6091 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6092 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6093 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6095 f->async_iconified = 1;
6097 inev.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6098 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6101 goto OTHER;
6103 case MapNotify:
6104 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6105 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6106 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6107 goto OTHER;
6109 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6110 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6111 frame is visible. */
6112 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6113 if (f)
6115 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6116 the frame's display structures.
6117 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6118 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6119 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6120 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6121 if (! f->async_iconified)
6122 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6124 f->async_visible = 1;
6125 f->async_iconified = 0;
6126 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6128 if (f->iconified)
6130 inev.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6131 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6133 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6134 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6135 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6136 to update the frame titles
6137 in case this is the second frame. */
6138 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6140 goto OTHER;
6142 case KeyPress:
6144 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6146 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6147 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6148 if (popup_activated ())
6149 goto OTHER;
6150 #endif
6152 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6154 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6156 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6157 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6160 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6161 if (f == 0)
6163 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6164 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6165 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6166 event.xkey.window);
6167 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6169 widget = XtParent (widget);
6170 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6173 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6175 if (f != 0)
6177 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6178 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6179 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6180 his Emacs hang.
6182 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6183 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6184 status_return even if the input is too long to
6185 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6186 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6187 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6188 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6189 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6190 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6191 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6192 int modifiers;
6193 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6194 Lisp_Object c;
6196 #ifdef USE_GTK
6197 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6198 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6199 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6200 (see above). */
6201 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6202 #endif
6204 event.xkey.state
6205 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6206 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6207 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6209 /* This will have to go some day... */
6211 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6212 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6213 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6214 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6215 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6216 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6217 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6219 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6220 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6221 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6222 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6223 not it is combined with Meta. */
6224 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6225 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6227 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6228 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6230 Status status_return;
6232 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6233 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6234 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6235 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6236 &status_return);
6237 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6239 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6240 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6241 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6242 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6243 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6244 &status_return);
6246 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6247 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6248 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6249 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6250 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6251 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6252 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6253 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6254 &status_return);
6255 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6257 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6258 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6259 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6260 &event.xkey,
6261 copy_bufptr,
6262 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6263 &status_return);
6266 #endif
6268 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6269 break;
6270 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6272 keysym = NoSymbol;
6273 modifiers = 0;
6275 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6276 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6277 abort ();
6279 else
6280 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6281 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6282 &compose_status);
6283 #else
6284 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6285 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6286 &compose_status);
6287 #endif
6289 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6290 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6291 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6292 break;
6294 orig_keysym = keysym;
6296 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6297 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6298 inev.modifiers
6299 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6300 inev.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6302 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6303 translations to characters. */
6304 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6305 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6307 inev.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6308 inev.code = keysym;
6309 goto done_keysym;
6312 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6313 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6314 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6315 Vx_keysym_table,
6316 Qnil))))
6318 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6319 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6320 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6321 inev.code = XFASTINT (c);
6322 goto done_keysym;
6325 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6326 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6327 || keysym == XK_Delete
6328 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6329 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6330 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6331 #endif
6332 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6333 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6334 #ifdef HPUX
6335 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6336 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6337 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6338 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6339 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6340 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6341 #endif
6342 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6343 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6344 #endif
6345 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6346 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6347 #endif
6348 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6349 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6350 #endif
6351 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6352 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6353 #endif
6354 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6355 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6356 #endif
6357 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6358 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6359 #endif
6360 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6361 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6362 #endif
6363 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6364 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6365 #endif
6366 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6367 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6368 #endif
6369 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6370 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6371 #endif
6372 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6373 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6374 #endif
6375 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6376 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6377 #endif
6378 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6379 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6380 #endif
6381 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6382 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6383 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6384 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6385 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6386 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6387 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6388 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6389 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6390 #endif
6391 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6392 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6393 #endif
6394 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6395 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6396 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6397 don't have real modifiers but
6398 should be treated similarly to
6399 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6400 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6401 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6402 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6403 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6404 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6405 #endif
6408 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6409 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6410 key. */
6411 inev.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6412 inev.code = keysym;
6413 goto done_keysym;
6416 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6417 register int i;
6418 register int c;
6419 int nchars, len;
6421 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6422 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6423 we used just above and the locale. */
6424 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6425 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6426 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6427 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6428 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6429 gives us composition information. */
6430 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6432 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6434 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6438 /* Decode the input data. */
6439 int require;
6440 unsigned char *p;
6442 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6443 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6444 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6445 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6446 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6447 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6448 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6449 nbytes = coding.produced;
6450 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6451 copy_bufptr = p;
6454 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6455 character events. */
6456 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6458 if (nchars == nbytes)
6459 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6460 else
6461 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6462 nbytes - i, len);
6463 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6464 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6465 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6466 inev.code = c;
6467 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6470 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6471 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6472 count += nbytes;
6474 inev.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6476 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6477 break;
6480 done_keysym:
6481 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6482 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6483 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6484 client. */
6485 break;
6486 #else
6487 goto OTHER;
6488 #endif
6490 case KeyRelease:
6491 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6492 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6493 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6494 client. */
6495 break;
6496 #else
6497 goto OTHER;
6498 #endif
6500 case EnterNotify:
6501 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6503 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6505 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6506 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6508 #if 0
6509 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6511 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6512 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6513 || !(f->auto_lower)
6514 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6516 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6517 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6520 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6521 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6522 #endif
6524 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6525 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6526 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6527 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6528 goto OTHER;
6530 case FocusIn:
6531 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6532 goto OTHER;
6534 case LeaveNotify:
6535 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6537 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6538 if (f)
6540 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6542 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6543 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6544 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6545 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6548 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6549 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6550 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6551 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6552 if (any_help_event_p)
6553 do_help = -1;
6555 goto OTHER;
6557 case FocusOut:
6558 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6559 goto OTHER;
6561 case MotionNotify:
6563 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6564 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6565 help_echo_pos = -1;
6567 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6568 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6569 f = last_mouse_frame;
6570 else
6571 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6573 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6575 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6576 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6579 if (f)
6582 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6583 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6585 Lisp_Object window;
6587 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6588 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6589 0, 0, 0, 0);
6591 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6592 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6593 will be selected iff it is active. */
6594 if (WINDOWP (window)
6595 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6596 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6598 inev.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6599 inev.frame_or_window = window;
6602 last_window=window;
6604 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6606 else
6608 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6609 struct scroll_bar *bar
6610 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6611 event.xmotion.window);
6613 if (bar)
6614 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6615 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6617 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6618 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6619 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6622 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6623 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6624 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6625 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6626 do_help = 1;
6627 goto OTHER;
6630 case ConfigureNotify:
6631 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6632 if (f)
6634 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6635 #ifdef USE_GTK
6636 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6637 event.xconfigure.height);
6638 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6639 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6640 do this one, the right one will come later.
6641 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6642 need to reset it below. */
6643 int dont_resize
6644 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6645 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6646 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6647 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6649 if (dont_resize)
6650 goto OTHER;
6652 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6653 is called by the code that handles resizing
6654 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6656 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6657 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6658 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6659 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6660 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6661 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6662 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6664 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6665 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6666 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6668 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6669 #endif
6671 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6672 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6674 #ifdef USE_GTK
6675 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6676 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6677 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6678 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6679 #endif
6681 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6682 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6683 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6685 x_check_expected_move (f);
6686 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6687 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6690 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6691 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6692 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6693 #endif
6695 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6697 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6698 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6699 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6700 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6703 goto OTHER;
6705 case ButtonRelease:
6706 case ButtonPress:
6708 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6709 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6710 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6712 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6714 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6715 && last_mouse_frame
6716 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6717 f = last_mouse_frame;
6718 else
6719 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6721 if (f)
6723 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6724 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6725 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6727 Lisp_Object window;
6728 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6729 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6731 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6732 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6734 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6735 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6736 else
6737 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6738 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6739 event.xbutton.state));
6740 tool_bar_p = 1;
6744 if (!tool_bar_p)
6745 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6746 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6748 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6749 if (! popup_activated ())
6750 #endif
6752 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6754 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6755 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6757 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6758 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6760 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6761 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6763 else
6764 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6768 else
6770 struct scroll_bar *bar
6771 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6772 event.xbutton.window);
6774 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6775 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6776 scroll bars. */
6777 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6779 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6780 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6782 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6783 if (bar)
6784 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6785 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6788 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6790 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6791 last_mouse_frame = f;
6792 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
6793 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
6794 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
6795 the ButtonPress. */
6796 if (f != 0)
6797 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6799 if (!tool_bar_p)
6800 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6802 else
6803 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6805 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6806 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6807 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6808 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6809 Instead, save it away
6810 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6811 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6812 if (
6813 #ifdef USE_GTK
6814 ! popup_activated ()
6816 #endif
6817 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6818 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6819 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6820 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6821 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6822 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6823 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6824 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6826 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6827 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6828 #ifdef USE_GTK
6829 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6830 #endif
6832 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6834 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6835 goto OTHER;
6838 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6839 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6840 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6842 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6844 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6845 if (f->output_data.x)
6846 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6848 else
6849 goto OTHER;
6851 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6852 else
6853 goto OTHER;
6854 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6856 break;
6858 case CirculateNotify:
6859 goto OTHER;
6861 case CirculateRequest:
6862 goto OTHER;
6864 case VisibilityNotify:
6865 goto OTHER;
6867 case MappingNotify:
6868 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6869 local cache. */
6870 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6872 case MappingModifier:
6873 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6874 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6875 case MappingKeyboard:
6876 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6878 goto OTHER;
6880 default:
6881 OTHER:
6882 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6883 BLOCK_INPUT;
6884 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6885 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6886 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6887 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6888 break;
6891 done:
6892 if (inev.kind != NO_EVENT)
6894 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6895 count++;
6898 if (do_help
6899 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6901 Lisp_Object frame;
6903 if (f)
6904 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6905 else
6906 frame = Qnil;
6908 if (do_help > 0)
6910 any_help_event_p = 1;
6911 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6912 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6914 else
6916 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6917 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6919 count++;
6922 *eventp = event;
6923 return count;
6927 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6928 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6929 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6931 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6933 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6934 XEvent *event;
6935 Display *display;
6937 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6938 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6940 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6942 if (dpyinfo)
6943 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6945 return finish;
6949 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6950 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6951 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6953 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6954 thus pretending to be `read'.
6956 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6958 static int
6959 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6960 register int sd;
6961 int expected;
6962 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6964 int count = 0;
6965 XEvent event;
6966 int event_found = 0;
6967 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6969 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6971 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6972 return -1;
6975 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6976 BLOCK_INPUT;
6978 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6979 input_signal_count++;
6981 ++handling_signal;
6983 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6984 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6985 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6987 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6988 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6989 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6990 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6991 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6992 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
6993 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
6994 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
6995 #endif
6997 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
6998 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
6999 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7000 for X connections. */
7001 #ifndef SIGIO
7002 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7003 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7005 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7006 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7007 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7008 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7010 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7011 #endif /* SIGIO */
7012 #endif
7014 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7015 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7017 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7018 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7021 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7023 struct input_event inev;
7024 BLOCK_INPUT;
7025 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7026 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7027 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7029 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7030 count++;
7032 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7034 #endif
7036 #ifndef USE_GTK
7037 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7039 int finish;
7041 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7043 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7044 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7045 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7046 break;
7047 #endif
7048 event_found = 1;
7050 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7052 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7053 goto out;
7055 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7058 #ifdef USE_GTK
7060 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7061 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7062 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7063 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7065 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7066 from all displays. */
7068 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7070 current_count = count;
7071 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7073 gtk_main_iteration ();
7075 count = current_count;
7076 current_count = -1;
7077 current_hold_quit = 0;
7079 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7080 break;
7082 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7084 out:;
7086 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7087 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7088 if (! event_found)
7090 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7091 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7092 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7093 x_noop_count++;
7094 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7096 x_noop_count=0;
7098 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7099 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7101 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7103 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7104 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7108 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7109 raise it now. */
7110 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7111 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7113 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7114 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7117 --handling_signal;
7118 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7120 return count;
7126 /***********************************************************************
7127 Text Cursor
7128 ***********************************************************************/
7130 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7131 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7133 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7134 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7135 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7137 static void
7138 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc)
7139 struct window *w;
7140 struct glyph_row *row;
7141 GC gc;
7143 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7144 XRectangle clip_rect;
7145 int window_y, window_width;
7147 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7149 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
7150 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
7151 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7152 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7153 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7155 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7159 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7161 static void
7162 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7163 struct window *w;
7164 struct glyph_row *row;
7166 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7167 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7168 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7169 int x, y, wd, h;
7170 XGCValues xgcv;
7171 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7172 GC gc;
7174 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7175 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7176 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7177 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7178 return;
7180 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
7181 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
7182 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
7183 width instead. */
7184 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
7185 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
7186 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
7187 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
7188 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
7190 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
7191 coordinates. */
7192 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7193 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y);
7195 /* Compute the proper height and ascent of the rectangle, based
7196 on the actual glyph. Using the full height of the row looks
7197 bad when there are tall images on that row. */
7198 h = max (min (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), row->height),
7199 cursor_glyph->ascent + cursor_glyph->descent);
7200 if (h < row->height)
7201 y += row->ascent /* - w->phys_cursor_ascent */ + cursor_glyph->descent - h;
7202 h--;
7204 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7205 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7206 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7207 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7208 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7209 else
7210 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7211 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7212 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7214 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7215 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7216 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7217 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7221 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7223 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7224 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7225 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7226 --gerd. */
7228 static void
7229 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7230 struct window *w;
7231 struct glyph_row *row;
7232 int width;
7233 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7235 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7236 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7238 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7239 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7240 and mini-buffer. */
7241 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7242 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7243 return;
7245 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7246 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7247 the bar might not be in the window. */
7248 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7250 struct glyph_row *row;
7251 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7252 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7254 else
7256 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7257 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7258 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7259 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7260 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7261 XGCValues xgcv;
7263 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7264 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7265 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7266 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7267 that the glyph is legible. */
7268 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7269 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7270 else
7271 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7272 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7274 if (gc)
7275 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7276 else
7278 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7279 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7282 if (width < 0)
7283 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7284 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7286 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7287 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7289 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7290 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7291 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7292 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7293 width, row->height);
7294 else
7295 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7296 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7297 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7298 row->height - width),
7299 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7300 width);
7302 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7307 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7309 static void
7310 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7311 struct frame *f;
7312 Cursor cursor;
7314 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7318 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7320 static void
7321 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7322 struct frame *f;
7323 int x, y, width, height;
7325 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7326 x, y, width, height, False);
7330 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7332 static void
7333 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7334 struct window *w;
7335 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7336 int x, y;
7337 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7338 int on_p, active_p;
7340 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7342 if (on_p)
7344 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7345 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7347 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7348 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7350 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7351 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7353 else
7354 switch (cursor_type)
7356 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7357 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7358 break;
7360 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7361 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7362 break;
7364 case BAR_CURSOR:
7365 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7366 break;
7368 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7369 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7370 break;
7372 case NO_CURSOR:
7373 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7374 break;
7376 default:
7377 abort ();
7380 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7381 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7382 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7383 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7384 #endif
7387 #ifndef XFlush
7388 if (updating_frame != f)
7389 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7390 #endif
7394 /* Icons. */
7396 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7399 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7400 struct frame *f;
7401 Lisp_Object file;
7403 int bitmap_id;
7405 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7406 return 1;
7408 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7409 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7410 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7411 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7413 if (STRINGP (file))
7415 #ifdef USE_GTK
7416 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7417 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7418 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7419 return 0;
7420 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7421 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7422 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7424 else
7426 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7427 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7429 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7430 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7431 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7432 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7435 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7436 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7437 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7438 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7439 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7441 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7444 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7445 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7447 return 0;
7451 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7452 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7455 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7456 struct frame *f;
7457 char *icon_name;
7459 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7460 return 1;
7462 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7464 XTextProperty text;
7465 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7466 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7467 text.format = 8;
7468 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7469 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7471 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7472 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7473 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7475 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7476 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7477 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7478 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7480 return 0;
7483 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7485 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7486 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7488 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7490 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7491 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7492 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7494 static void
7495 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7496 Display *display;
7497 XErrorEvent *error;
7499 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7500 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7501 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7504 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7505 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7506 operating on.
7508 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7509 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7510 stored in x_error_message_string.
7512 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7513 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7515 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7517 void x_check_errors ();
7518 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7521 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7522 Display *dpy;
7524 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7526 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7527 XSync (dpy, False);
7529 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7530 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7531 x_error_message_string));
7533 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7534 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7536 return count;
7539 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7541 static Lisp_Object
7542 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7543 Lisp_Object old_val;
7545 Lisp_Object first = XCAR (old_val);
7546 Display *dpy = XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer;
7548 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7549 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7550 if (x_display_info_for_display (dpy) != 0)
7552 BLOCK_INPUT;
7553 XSync (dpy, False);
7554 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7557 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7558 return Qnil;
7561 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7562 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7563 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7565 void
7566 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7567 Display *dpy;
7568 char *format;
7570 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7571 XSync (dpy, False);
7573 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7574 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7577 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7578 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7581 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7582 Display *dpy;
7584 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7585 XSync (dpy, False);
7587 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7590 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7592 void
7593 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7594 Display *dpy;
7596 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7599 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7600 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7601 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7602 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7604 void
7605 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7606 Display *dpy;
7607 int count;
7609 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7612 #if 0
7613 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7614 x_trace_wire ()
7616 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7618 #endif /* ! 0 */
7621 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7622 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7623 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7624 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7625 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7627 static SIGTYPE
7628 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7629 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7631 #ifdef USG
7632 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7633 must reestablish each time */
7634 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7635 #endif /* USG */
7639 /************************************************************************
7640 Handling X errors
7641 ************************************************************************/
7643 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7645 static char *error_msg;
7647 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7648 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7649 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7651 static void
7652 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7654 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7655 exit (70);
7658 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7659 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7661 static SIGTYPE
7662 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7663 Display *dpy;
7664 char *error_message;
7666 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7667 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7668 int count;
7670 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7671 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7672 handling_signal = 0;
7674 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7675 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7676 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7677 the original message here. */
7678 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7680 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7681 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7682 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7684 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7685 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7686 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7688 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7689 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7691 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7692 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7693 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7695 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7696 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7697 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7698 if (dpyinfo)
7700 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7701 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7702 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7703 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7705 #endif
7707 #ifdef USE_GTK
7708 if (dpyinfo)
7709 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7710 #endif
7712 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7713 if (dpyinfo)
7714 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7716 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7717 that are on the dead display. */
7718 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7720 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7721 minibuf_frame
7722 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7723 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7724 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7725 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7726 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7727 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7730 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7731 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7732 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7733 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7734 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7735 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7737 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7738 trying to find a replacement. */
7739 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7740 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7743 if (dpyinfo)
7744 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7746 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7748 if (x_display_list == 0)
7750 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7751 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7752 exit (70);
7755 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7756 #ifdef SIGIO
7757 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7758 #endif
7759 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7760 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7762 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7763 error ("%s", error_msg);
7767 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7768 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7769 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7771 static void
7772 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7773 Display *display;
7774 XErrorEvent *error;
7776 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7778 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7779 original error handler. */
7781 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7782 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7783 buf, error->request_code);
7784 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7788 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7789 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7791 static int
7792 x_error_handler (display, error)
7793 Display *display;
7794 XErrorEvent *error;
7796 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7797 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7798 else
7799 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7800 return 0;
7803 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7804 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7805 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7807 static int
7808 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7809 Display *display;
7811 char buf[256];
7813 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7814 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7815 return 0;
7818 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7820 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7821 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7822 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7823 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7825 Lisp_Object
7826 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7827 struct frame *f;
7828 register char *fontname;
7830 struct font_info *fontp
7831 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7833 if (!fontp)
7834 return Qnil;
7836 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7837 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7838 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7840 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (f));
7841 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7843 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7845 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7846 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7848 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7849 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7850 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7852 else
7854 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7855 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7858 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7859 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7861 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7862 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7863 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7864 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7865 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7866 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7868 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7869 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7870 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7871 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7872 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7875 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7878 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7879 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7880 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7881 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7883 Lisp_Object
7884 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7885 struct frame *f;
7886 char *fontsetname;
7888 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7889 Lisp_Object result;
7891 if (fontset < 0)
7892 return Qnil;
7894 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7895 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7896 to do. */
7897 return fontset_name (fontset);
7899 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7901 if (!STRINGP (result))
7902 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7903 return Qnil;
7905 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7906 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7908 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7909 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7910 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7911 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7912 #endif
7914 return build_string (fontsetname);
7918 /***********************************************************************
7919 X Input Methods
7920 ***********************************************************************/
7922 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7924 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7926 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7927 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7928 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7930 static void
7931 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7932 XIM xim;
7933 XPointer client_data;
7934 XPointer call_data;
7936 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7937 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7939 BLOCK_INPUT;
7941 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7942 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7944 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7945 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7947 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7948 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7952 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7953 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7954 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7955 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7958 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7960 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7961 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7962 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7963 #endif
7965 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7966 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7968 static void
7969 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7970 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7971 char *resource_name;
7973 XIM xim;
7975 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7976 if (use_xim)
7978 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7979 EMACS_CLASS);
7980 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7982 if (xim)
7984 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7985 XIMCallback destroy;
7986 #endif
7988 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7989 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7991 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7992 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7993 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7994 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7995 #endif
7999 else
8000 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8001 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8005 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8007 struct xim_inst_t
8009 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8010 char *resource_name;
8013 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8014 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8015 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8016 when the callback was registered. */
8018 static void
8019 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8020 Display *display;
8021 XPointer client_data;
8022 XPointer call_data;
8024 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8025 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8027 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8028 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8029 return;
8031 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8033 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8034 as they have no XIC. */
8035 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8037 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8039 BLOCK_INPUT;
8040 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8042 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8044 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8045 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8047 create_frame_xic (f);
8048 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8049 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8050 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8052 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8053 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8058 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8062 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8065 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8066 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8067 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8068 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8070 static void
8071 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8072 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8073 char *resource_name;
8075 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8076 if (use_xim)
8078 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8079 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8080 int len;
8082 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8083 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8084 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8085 len = strlen (resource_name);
8086 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8087 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8088 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8089 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8090 xim_instantiate_callback,
8091 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8092 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8093 least, hence the configure test. */
8094 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8095 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8096 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8097 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8098 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8101 else
8102 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8103 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8107 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8109 static void
8110 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8111 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8113 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8114 if (use_xim)
8116 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8117 if (dpyinfo->display)
8118 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8119 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8120 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8121 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8122 if (dpyinfo->display)
8123 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8124 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8125 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8127 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8130 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8134 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8135 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8137 void
8138 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8139 struct frame *f;
8141 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8142 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8144 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8145 is already for the top-left corner. */
8146 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8147 return;
8149 /* Find the offsets of the outside upper-left corner of
8150 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
8151 But do this only if we will need the results. */
8152 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8153 /* This is to get *_pixels_outer_diff. */
8154 x_real_positions (f, &win_x, &win_y);
8156 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8157 position that fits on the screen. */
8158 if (flags & XNegative)
8159 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8160 - 2 * FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->x_pixels_outer_diff
8161 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
8162 + f->left_pos);
8165 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8167 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8168 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8169 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8171 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8172 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8173 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8174 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8175 is right, though.
8177 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8178 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8180 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8181 #endif
8183 if (flags & YNegative)
8184 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
8185 - FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->y_pixels_outer_diff
8187 /* Assume the window manager decorations are the same size on
8188 three sides, i.e. left, right and bottom. This is to
8189 compensate for the bottom part. */
8190 - FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->x_pixels_outer_diff
8191 - height
8192 + f->top_pos);
8195 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8196 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8197 so the flags should correspond. */
8198 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8201 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8202 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8203 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8204 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8205 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8207 void
8208 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8209 struct frame *f;
8210 register int xoff, yoff;
8211 int change_gravity;
8213 int modified_top, modified_left;
8215 if (change_gravity > 0)
8217 f->top_pos = yoff;
8218 f->left_pos = xoff;
8219 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8220 if (xoff < 0)
8221 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8222 if (yoff < 0)
8223 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8224 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8226 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8228 BLOCK_INPUT;
8229 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8231 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8232 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8234 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8236 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8237 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8238 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8239 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8240 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8243 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8244 modified_left, modified_top);
8246 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8247 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8249 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8250 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8251 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8254 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8257 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8258 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8259 static void
8260 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8261 struct frame *f;
8263 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8265 int width, height, ign;
8267 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8269 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8271 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8272 when setting WM manager hints.
8273 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8274 x_check_expected_move. */
8275 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8277 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8278 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8279 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8281 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8282 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8287 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8288 the window.
8289 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8290 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8291 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8292 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8293 static void
8294 x_check_expected_move (f)
8295 struct frame *f;
8297 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8299 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8300 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8302 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8304 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8305 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8306 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8308 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
8310 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8311 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8313 /* Just do this once */
8314 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8319 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8320 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8321 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8322 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8324 static void
8325 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8326 struct frame *f;
8327 int change_gravity;
8328 int cols, rows;
8330 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8332 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8333 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8334 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8336 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8337 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8338 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8340 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8342 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8343 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8345 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8346 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8348 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8349 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8350 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8352 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8353 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8354 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8355 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8357 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8358 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8359 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8360 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8361 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8363 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8364 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8365 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8366 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8367 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8369 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8370 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8371 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8372 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8373 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8375 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8379 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8380 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8381 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8382 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8384 void
8385 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8386 struct frame *f;
8387 int change_gravity;
8388 int cols, rows;
8390 BLOCK_INPUT;
8392 #ifdef USE_GTK
8393 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8394 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8395 else
8396 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8397 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8399 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8401 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8402 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8403 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8404 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8405 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8406 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8407 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8408 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8409 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8411 else
8412 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8414 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8416 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8418 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8420 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8421 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8423 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8424 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8425 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8426 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8427 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8429 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8432 /* Mouse warping. */
8434 void
8435 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8436 struct frame *f;
8437 int x, y;
8439 int pix_x, pix_y;
8441 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8442 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8444 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8445 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8447 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8448 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8450 BLOCK_INPUT;
8452 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8453 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8454 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8457 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8459 void
8460 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8461 struct frame *f;
8462 int pix_x, pix_y;
8464 BLOCK_INPUT;
8466 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8467 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8468 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8471 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8473 void
8474 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8475 struct frame *f;
8477 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8478 x_raise_frame (f);
8479 #endif
8480 #if 0
8481 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8482 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8483 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8484 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8485 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8486 #endif /* ! 0 */
8489 void
8490 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8491 struct frame *f;
8493 #if 0
8494 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8495 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8496 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8497 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8498 #endif /* ! 0 */
8501 /* Raise frame F. */
8503 void
8504 x_raise_frame (f)
8505 struct frame *f;
8507 if (f->async_visible)
8509 BLOCK_INPUT;
8510 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8511 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8512 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8516 /* Lower frame F. */
8518 void
8519 x_lower_frame (f)
8520 struct frame *f;
8522 if (f->async_visible)
8524 BLOCK_INPUT;
8525 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8526 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8527 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8531 static void
8532 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8533 FRAME_PTR f;
8534 int raise_flag;
8536 if (raise_flag)
8537 x_raise_frame (f);
8538 else
8539 x_lower_frame (f);
8542 /* Change of visibility. */
8544 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8545 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8546 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8547 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8548 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8549 finishes with it. */
8551 void
8552 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8553 struct frame *f;
8555 Lisp_Object type;
8556 int original_top, original_left;
8557 int retry_count = 2;
8559 retry:
8561 BLOCK_INPUT;
8563 type = x_icon_type (f);
8564 if (!NILP (type))
8565 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8567 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8569 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8570 call x_set_offset a second time
8571 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8572 before the window gets really visible. */
8573 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8574 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8575 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8577 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8579 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8580 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8581 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8582 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8583 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8584 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8585 #ifdef USE_GTK
8586 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8587 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8588 #else
8589 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8590 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8591 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8592 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8593 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8594 to come back ok without this. */
8595 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8596 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8597 #endif
8600 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8602 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8603 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8604 so that incoming events are handled. */
8606 Lisp_Object frame;
8607 int count;
8608 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8609 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8610 will set it when they are handled. */
8611 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8613 original_left = f->left_pos;
8614 original_top = f->top_pos;
8616 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8617 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8619 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8621 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8622 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8623 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8624 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8626 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8627 because the window manager may choose the position
8628 and we don't want to override it. */
8630 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8631 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8632 && previously_visible)
8634 Drawable rootw;
8635 int x, y;
8636 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8638 BLOCK_INPUT;
8640 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8641 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8642 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8643 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8644 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8645 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8646 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8647 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8648 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8650 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8651 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8652 original_left, original_top);
8654 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8657 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8659 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8660 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8661 MapNotify at all.. */
8662 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8663 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8665 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8666 x_sync (f);
8668 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8669 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8670 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8671 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8672 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8673 probably a bug. */
8674 if (input_polling_used ())
8676 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8677 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8678 handler reset it. */
8679 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8680 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8681 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8682 poll_for_input_1 ();
8683 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8686 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8687 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8690 /* 2000-09-28: In
8692 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8693 (iconify-frame f)
8694 (raise-frame f))
8696 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8697 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8698 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8699 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8701 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8702 goto retry;
8706 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8708 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8710 void
8711 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8712 struct frame *f;
8714 Window window;
8716 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8717 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8719 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8720 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8721 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8723 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8724 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8725 return;
8726 #endif
8728 BLOCK_INPUT;
8730 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8731 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8732 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8733 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8734 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8735 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8737 #ifdef USE_GTK
8738 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8739 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8740 else
8741 #endif
8743 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8745 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8746 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8748 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8749 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8751 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8753 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8754 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8756 XEvent unmap;
8758 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8759 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8760 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8761 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8762 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8763 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8764 False,
8765 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8766 &unmap))
8768 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8769 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8773 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8774 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8775 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8778 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8779 just by the event that we get from the server.
8780 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8781 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8782 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8783 f->visible = 0;
8784 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8785 f->async_visible = 0;
8786 f->async_iconified = 0;
8788 x_sync (f);
8790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8793 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8795 void
8796 x_iconify_frame (f)
8797 struct frame *f;
8799 int result;
8800 Lisp_Object type;
8802 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8803 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8804 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8806 if (f->async_iconified)
8807 return;
8809 BLOCK_INPUT;
8811 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8813 type = x_icon_type (f);
8814 if (!NILP (type))
8815 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8817 #ifdef USE_GTK
8818 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8820 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8821 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8823 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8824 f->iconified = 1;
8825 f->visible = 1;
8826 f->async_iconified = 1;
8827 f->async_visible = 0;
8828 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8829 return;
8831 #endif
8833 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8835 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8837 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8838 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8839 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8840 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8841 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8842 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8843 so we have to record it here. */
8844 f->iconified = 1;
8845 f->visible = 1;
8846 f->async_iconified = 1;
8847 f->async_visible = 0;
8848 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8849 return;
8852 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8853 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8854 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8855 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8857 if (!result)
8858 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8860 f->async_iconified = 1;
8861 f->async_visible = 0;
8864 BLOCK_INPUT;
8865 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8866 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8867 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8869 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8870 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8871 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8872 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8874 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8875 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8877 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8878 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8880 XEvent message;
8882 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8883 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8884 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8885 message.xclient.format = 32;
8886 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8888 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8889 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8890 False,
8891 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8892 &message))
8894 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8895 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8899 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8900 IconicState. */
8901 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8903 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8905 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8906 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8909 f->async_iconified = 1;
8910 f->async_visible = 0;
8912 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8913 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8914 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8918 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8920 void
8921 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8922 struct frame *f;
8924 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8925 Lisp_Object bar;
8926 struct scroll_bar *b;
8928 BLOCK_INPUT;
8930 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8931 commands to the X server. */
8932 if (dpyinfo->display)
8934 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8935 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8937 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8938 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8939 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8940 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8941 toolkit scroll bars. */
8942 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8944 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8945 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8947 #endif
8949 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8950 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8951 free_frame_xic (f);
8952 #endif
8954 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8955 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8957 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8958 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8960 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8961 we are using a toolkit. */
8962 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8963 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8965 free_frame_menubar (f);
8966 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8968 #ifdef USE_GTK
8969 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8970 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8971 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8973 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8974 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8975 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8977 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8979 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8980 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8981 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8983 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8984 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8985 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8986 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8987 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8988 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8990 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8991 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8992 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8993 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8994 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
8995 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
8996 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
8997 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
8998 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
8999 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9000 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9001 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9002 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9003 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9004 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9006 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9007 free_frame_faces (f);
9009 x_free_gcs (f);
9010 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9013 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9014 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9016 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9017 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9019 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9020 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9021 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9022 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9023 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9024 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9026 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9028 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9029 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9030 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9031 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9032 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9033 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9034 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9037 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9041 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9043 void
9044 x_destroy_window (f)
9045 struct frame *f;
9047 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9049 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9050 commands to the X server. */
9051 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9052 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9054 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9058 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9060 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9061 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9062 that the window now has.
9063 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9064 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9065 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9067 #ifndef USE_GTK
9068 void
9069 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9070 struct frame *f;
9071 long flags;
9072 int user_position;
9074 XSizeHints size_hints;
9076 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9077 Arg al[2];
9078 int ac = 0;
9079 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9080 #endif
9082 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9084 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9085 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9087 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9088 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9090 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9091 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9092 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9093 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9094 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9095 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9096 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9097 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9098 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9099 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9101 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9102 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9103 size_hints.max_width
9104 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9105 size_hints.max_height
9106 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9108 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9110 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9111 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9112 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9114 int base_width, base_height;
9115 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9117 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9118 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9120 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9122 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9123 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9124 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9125 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9126 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9128 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9129 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9130 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9132 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9133 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9134 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9135 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9136 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9137 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9138 #else
9139 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9140 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9141 #endif
9144 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9145 if (flags)
9147 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9148 goto no_read;
9150 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9153 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9154 long supplied_return;
9155 int value;
9157 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9158 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9159 &supplied_return);
9160 #else
9161 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9162 #endif
9164 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9165 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9166 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9167 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9168 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9169 #endif
9171 if (flags)
9172 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9173 else
9175 if (value == 0)
9176 hints.flags = 0;
9177 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9178 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9179 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9180 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9181 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9182 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9183 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9184 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9188 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9189 no_read:
9190 #endif
9192 #ifdef PWinGravity
9193 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9194 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9196 if (user_position)
9198 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9199 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9201 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9203 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9204 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9205 #else
9206 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9207 #endif
9209 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9211 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9213 void
9214 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9215 struct frame *f;
9216 int state;
9218 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9219 Arg al[1];
9221 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9222 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9223 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9224 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9226 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9227 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9229 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9230 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9233 void
9234 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9235 struct frame *f;
9236 int pixmap_id;
9238 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9240 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9241 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9242 #endif
9244 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9246 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9247 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9248 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9249 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9251 else
9253 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9254 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9255 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9256 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9257 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9258 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9259 best to explicitly give up. */
9260 #if 0
9261 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9262 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9263 #else
9264 return;
9265 #endif
9268 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9271 Arg al[1];
9272 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9273 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9274 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9275 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9278 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9280 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9281 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9283 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9286 void
9287 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9288 struct frame *f;
9289 int icon_x, icon_y;
9291 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9293 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9294 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9295 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9297 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9301 /***********************************************************************
9302 Fonts
9303 ***********************************************************************/
9305 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9307 struct font_info *
9308 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9309 FRAME_PTR f;
9310 int font_idx;
9312 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9316 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9318 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9319 to be listed.
9321 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9323 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9324 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9325 on how many fonts to match. */
9327 Lisp_Object
9328 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9329 struct frame *f;
9330 Lisp_Object pattern;
9331 int size;
9332 int maxnames;
9334 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9335 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9336 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9337 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9338 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9339 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9340 int count;
9341 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9343 if (size < 0)
9345 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9346 size = 0;
9349 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9350 if (NILP (patterns))
9351 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9353 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9354 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9355 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9357 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9359 int num_fonts;
9360 char **names = NULL;
9362 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9363 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9364 The cache is an alist of the form:
9365 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9366 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9367 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9368 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9369 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9370 if (!NILP (list))
9372 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9373 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9374 goto label_cached;
9377 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9379 BLOCK_INPUT;
9380 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9382 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9384 XFontStruct *font;
9385 unsigned long value;
9387 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9388 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9390 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9391 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9392 font = NULL;
9393 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9396 if (font
9397 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9399 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9400 int len = strlen (name);
9401 char *tmp;
9403 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9404 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9405 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9406 if (len == 0)
9407 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9408 else
9410 num_fonts = 1;
9411 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9412 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9413 simple var. */
9414 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9415 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9416 XFree (name);
9419 else
9420 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9422 if (font)
9423 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9426 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9428 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9429 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9430 if (maxnames < 0)
9432 int limit;
9434 for (limit = 500;;)
9436 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9437 if (num_fonts == limit)
9439 BLOCK_INPUT;
9440 XFreeFontNames (names);
9441 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9442 limit *= 2;
9444 else
9445 break;
9448 else
9449 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9450 &num_fonts);
9452 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9454 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9455 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9456 names = NULL;
9457 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9461 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9462 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9464 if (names)
9466 int i;
9468 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9469 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9470 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9472 int width = 0;
9473 char *p = names[i];
9474 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9476 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9477 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9478 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9479 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9480 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9481 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9482 while (*p)
9483 if (*p++ == '-')
9485 dashes++;
9486 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9487 width = atoi (p);
9488 else if (dashes == 9)
9489 resx = atoi (p);
9490 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9491 average_width = atoi (p);
9494 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9495 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9497 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9498 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9500 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9501 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9502 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9503 >= 0))
9504 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9505 width of this font. */
9506 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9507 else
9508 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9509 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9514 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9516 BLOCK_INPUT;
9517 XFreeFontNames (names);
9518 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9522 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9523 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9524 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9526 label_cached:
9527 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9529 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9530 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9531 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9533 int found_size;
9535 tem = XCAR (list);
9537 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9538 continue;
9539 if (!size)
9541 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9542 continue;
9545 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9547 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9548 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9549 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9551 BLOCK_INPUT;
9552 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9553 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9554 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9555 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9557 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9558 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9559 thisinfo = NULL;
9560 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9562 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9563 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9565 if (thisinfo)
9567 XSETCDR (tem,
9568 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9569 ? make_number (0)
9570 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9571 BLOCK_INPUT;
9572 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9573 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9575 else
9576 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9577 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9578 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9579 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9582 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9583 if (found_size == size)
9584 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9585 else if (found_size > 0)
9587 if (NILP (second_best))
9588 second_best = tem;
9589 else if (found_size < size)
9591 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9592 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9593 second_best = tem;
9595 else
9597 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9598 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9599 second_best = tem;
9603 if (!NILP (newlist))
9604 break;
9605 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9607 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9608 break;
9612 return newlist;
9616 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9618 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9619 font table. */
9621 static void
9622 x_check_font (f, font)
9623 struct frame *f;
9624 XFontStruct *font;
9626 int i;
9627 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9629 xassert (font != NULL);
9631 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9632 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9633 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9634 break;
9636 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9639 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9641 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9642 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9643 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9644 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9645 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9647 static INLINE void
9648 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9649 XFontStruct *font;
9650 int *w, *h;
9652 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9653 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9655 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9656 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9657 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9658 if (*w <= 0)
9659 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9663 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9664 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9665 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9666 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9667 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9669 static int
9670 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9671 struct frame *f;
9673 int i;
9674 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9675 XFontStruct *font;
9676 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9677 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9679 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9680 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9682 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9683 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9685 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9686 int w, h;
9688 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9689 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9690 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9692 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9693 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9696 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9697 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9699 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9700 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9701 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9705 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9706 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9707 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9708 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9710 struct font_info *
9711 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9712 struct frame *f;
9713 register char *fontname;
9714 int size;
9716 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9717 Lisp_Object font_names;
9718 int count;
9720 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9721 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9722 we already have by comparing names. */
9723 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9725 if (!NILP (font_names))
9727 Lisp_Object tail;
9728 int i;
9730 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9731 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9732 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9733 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9734 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9735 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9736 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9737 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9740 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9742 char *full_name;
9743 XFontStruct *font;
9744 struct font_info *fontp;
9745 unsigned long value;
9746 int i;
9748 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9749 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9750 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9751 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9752 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9753 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9754 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9756 BLOCK_INPUT;
9757 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9758 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9759 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9761 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9762 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9763 font = NULL;
9764 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9766 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9767 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9768 if (!font)
9769 return NULL;
9771 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9772 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9773 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9774 break;
9776 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9777 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9778 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9780 int sz;
9781 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9782 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9783 dpyinfo->font_table
9784 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9787 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9788 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9789 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9791 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9792 BLOCK_INPUT;
9793 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9794 fontp->font = font;
9795 fontp->font_idx = i;
9796 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9797 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9799 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9800 full_name = 0;
9801 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9803 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9804 char *p = name;
9805 int dashes = 0;
9807 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9808 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9809 so don't use it.
9810 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9811 stored in them. */
9812 while (*p)
9814 if (*p == '-')
9815 dashes++;
9816 p++;
9819 if (dashes >= 13)
9821 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9822 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9825 XFree (name);
9828 if (full_name != 0)
9829 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9830 else
9831 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9833 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9834 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9836 if (NILP (font_names))
9838 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9839 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9840 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9841 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9842 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9843 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9844 Qnil);
9846 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9847 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9848 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9849 make_number (fontp->size)),
9850 Qnil)),
9851 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9852 if (full_name)
9854 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9855 Qnil);
9856 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9857 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9858 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9859 make_number (fontp->size)),
9860 Qnil)),
9861 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9865 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9866 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9867 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9868 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9869 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9870 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9871 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9872 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9873 fontp->encoding[1]
9874 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9875 /* 1-byte font */
9876 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9877 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9878 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9879 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9880 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9881 /* 2-byte font */
9882 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9883 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9884 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9885 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9886 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9887 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9888 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9889 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9890 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9891 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9892 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9893 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9894 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9896 fontp->baseline_offset
9897 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9898 ? (long) value : 0);
9899 fontp->relative_compose
9900 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9901 ? (long) value : 0);
9902 fontp->default_ascent
9903 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9904 ? (long) value : 0);
9906 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9907 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9908 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9909 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9910 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9911 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9912 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9913 return fontp;
9918 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9919 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9921 struct font_info *
9922 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9923 struct frame *f;
9924 register char *fontname;
9926 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9927 int i;
9929 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9930 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9931 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9932 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9933 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9934 return NULL;
9938 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9939 `encoder' of the structure. */
9941 void
9942 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9943 struct font_info *fontp;
9945 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9947 elt = Qnil;
9948 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9950 elt = XCAR (list);
9951 if (CONSP (elt)
9952 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9953 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9954 >= 0)
9955 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9956 >= 0)))
9957 break;
9960 if (! NILP (list))
9962 struct ccl_program *ccl
9963 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
9965 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
9966 xfree (ccl);
9967 else
9968 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
9974 /***********************************************************************
9975 Initialization
9976 ***********************************************************************/
9978 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9979 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9980 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9981 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9983 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9984 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9985 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9987 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9988 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9989 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9990 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9991 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9992 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9993 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9995 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9997 static int x_initialized;
9999 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10000 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10001 the screen number from the server number. */
10002 static int
10003 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10004 const char *name1, *name2;
10006 int seen_colon = 0;
10007 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10008 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10009 int length_until_period = 0;
10011 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10012 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10013 length_until_period++;
10015 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10016 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10017 name1 += 4;
10018 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10019 name2 += 4;
10020 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10021 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10022 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10023 name1 += system_name_length;
10024 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10025 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10026 name2 += system_name_length;
10027 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10028 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10029 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10030 name1 += length_until_period;
10031 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10032 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10033 name2 += length_until_period;
10035 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10037 if (*name1 == ':')
10038 seen_colon++;
10039 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10040 return 1;
10042 return (seen_colon
10043 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10044 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10046 #endif
10048 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10049 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10050 to 5. */
10051 static void
10052 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10053 unsigned long mask;
10054 int *bits;
10055 int *offset;
10057 int nr = 0;
10058 int off = 0;
10060 while (!(mask & 1))
10062 off++;
10063 mask >>= 1;
10066 while (mask & 1)
10068 nr++;
10069 mask >>= 1;
10072 *offset = off;
10073 *bits = nr;
10076 struct x_display_info *
10077 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10078 Lisp_Object display_name;
10079 char *xrm_option;
10080 char *resource_name;
10082 int connection;
10083 Display *dpy;
10084 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10085 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10087 BLOCK_INPUT;
10089 if (!x_initialized)
10091 x_initialize ();
10092 ++x_initialized;
10095 #ifdef USE_GTK
10097 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10098 int argc;
10099 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10100 char **argv2 = argv;
10101 GdkAtom atom;
10103 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10105 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10106 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10107 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10108 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10109 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10111 else
10113 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10114 argv[argc] = 0;
10116 argc = 0;
10117 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10119 if (! NILP (display_name))
10121 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10122 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10125 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10126 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10128 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10129 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10130 #endif
10132 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10134 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10135 fixup_locale ();
10136 xg_initialize ();
10138 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10140 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10141 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10143 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10145 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10146 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10147 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10149 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10150 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10151 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10153 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10154 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10156 UNGCPRO;
10159 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10160 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10163 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10164 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10165 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10166 errors with X11R5:
10167 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10168 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10169 So let's not use it until R6. */
10170 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10171 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10172 #endif
10175 int argc = 0;
10176 char *argv[3];
10178 argv[0] = "";
10179 argc = 1;
10180 if (xrm_option)
10182 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10183 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10185 turn_on_atimers (0);
10186 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10187 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10188 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10189 &argc, argv);
10190 turn_on_atimers (1);
10192 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10193 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10194 fixup_locale ();
10195 #endif
10198 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10199 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10200 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10201 #endif
10202 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10203 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10204 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10206 /* Detect failure. */
10207 if (dpy == 0)
10209 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10210 return 0;
10213 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10215 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10216 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10218 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10220 struct x_display_info *share;
10221 Lisp_Object tail;
10223 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10224 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10225 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10226 SDATA (display_name)))
10227 break;
10228 if (share)
10229 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10230 else
10232 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10233 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10234 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10236 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10237 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10238 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10239 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10240 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10241 BLOCK_INPUT;
10244 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10245 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10246 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10247 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10248 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10249 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10250 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10252 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10254 #endif
10256 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10257 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10258 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10260 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10261 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10262 x_display_name_list);
10263 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10265 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10267 #if 0
10268 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10269 #endif /* ! 0 */
10271 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10272 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10273 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10274 + 2);
10275 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10276 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10278 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10279 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10281 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10282 #ifdef USE_GTK
10283 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10284 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10285 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10287 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10288 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10290 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10291 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10292 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10293 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10294 #else
10295 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10296 #endif
10297 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10298 all versions. */
10299 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10301 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10302 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10303 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10304 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10305 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10306 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10307 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10308 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10309 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10310 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10311 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10312 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10313 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10314 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10315 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10316 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10317 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10318 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10319 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10320 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10321 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10322 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10323 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10324 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10325 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10326 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10327 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10328 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10329 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10330 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10331 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10332 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10333 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10335 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10336 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10337 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10339 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10341 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10342 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10343 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10344 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10345 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10346 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10349 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10350 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10352 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10354 Lisp_Object value;
10355 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10356 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10357 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10358 Qnil, Qnil);
10359 if (STRINGP (value)
10360 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10361 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10362 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10365 else
10366 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10367 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10370 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10371 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10372 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10373 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10374 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10375 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10376 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10377 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10378 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10381 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10382 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10383 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10384 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10385 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10386 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10387 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10388 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10389 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10390 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10391 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10392 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10393 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10394 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10395 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10396 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10397 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10398 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10399 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10400 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10401 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10402 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10403 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10404 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10405 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10406 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10407 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10408 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10409 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10410 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10411 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10412 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10413 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10414 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10415 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10416 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10417 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10418 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10419 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10420 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10421 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10422 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10423 /* For properties of font. */
10424 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10425 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10426 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10427 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10428 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10429 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10430 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10431 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10433 /* Ghostscript support. */
10434 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10435 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10437 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10438 False);
10440 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10442 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10443 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10446 char null_bits[1];
10448 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10450 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10451 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10452 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10457 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10458 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10459 dpyinfo->gray
10460 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10461 gray_bitmap_bits,
10462 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10463 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10466 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10467 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10468 #endif
10470 #ifdef subprocesses
10471 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10472 if (connection != 0)
10473 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10474 #endif
10476 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10477 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10478 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10479 /* stdin is a socket here */
10480 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10481 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10482 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10483 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10484 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10485 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10487 #ifdef SIGIO
10488 if (interrupt_input)
10489 init_sigio (connection);
10490 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10492 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10493 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10494 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10495 so that Xt does not crash. */
10497 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10498 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10499 Font font;
10500 int count;
10502 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10503 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10504 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10505 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10506 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10507 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10508 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10509 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10510 abort ();
10511 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10512 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10513 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10515 #endif
10516 #endif
10518 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10519 for debugging X code. */
10521 Lisp_Object value;
10522 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10523 build_string ("synchronous"),
10524 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10525 Qnil, Qnil);
10526 if (STRINGP (value)
10527 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10528 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10529 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10533 Lisp_Object value;
10534 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10535 build_string ("useXIM"),
10536 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10537 Qnil, Qnil);
10538 #ifdef USE_XIM
10539 if (STRINGP (value)
10540 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10541 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10542 use_xim = 0;
10543 #else
10544 if (STRINGP (value)
10545 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10546 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10547 use_xim = 1;
10548 #endif
10551 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10552 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10553 if (x_initialized == 1)
10554 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10555 #endif
10557 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10559 return dpyinfo;
10562 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10563 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10565 void
10566 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10567 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10569 int i;
10571 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10573 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10574 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10575 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10576 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10577 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10578 else
10580 Lisp_Object tail;
10582 tail = x_display_name_list;
10583 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10585 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10587 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10588 break;
10590 tail = XCDR (tail);
10594 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10595 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10597 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10598 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10599 else
10601 struct x_display_info *tail;
10603 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10604 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10605 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10608 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10609 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10610 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10611 #endif
10612 #endif
10613 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10614 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10615 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10616 #endif
10617 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10618 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10619 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10620 #endif
10622 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10623 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10624 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10626 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10627 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10628 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10631 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10632 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10634 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10635 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10636 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10637 xfree (dpyinfo);
10640 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10642 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10643 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10644 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10645 that slows us down. */
10647 static void
10648 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10649 struct atimer *timer;
10651 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10653 BLOCK_INPUT;
10654 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10655 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10656 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10660 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10663 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10665 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10667 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10669 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10670 x_produce_glyphs,
10671 x_write_glyphs,
10672 x_insert_glyphs,
10673 x_clear_end_of_line,
10674 x_scroll_run,
10675 x_after_update_window_line,
10676 x_update_window_begin,
10677 x_update_window_end,
10678 x_cursor_to,
10679 x_flush,
10680 #ifdef XFlush
10681 x_flush,
10682 #else
10683 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10684 #endif
10685 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10686 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10687 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10688 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10689 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10690 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10691 x_per_char_metric,
10692 x_encode_char,
10693 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10694 x_draw_glyph_string,
10695 x_define_frame_cursor,
10696 x_clear_frame_area,
10697 x_draw_window_cursor,
10698 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10699 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10702 void
10703 x_initialize ()
10705 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10707 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10708 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10709 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10710 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10711 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10712 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10713 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10714 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10715 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10716 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10717 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10718 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10719 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10720 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10721 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10722 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10723 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10724 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10726 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10727 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10728 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10729 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10730 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10731 off the bottom */
10732 baud_rate = 19200;
10734 x_noop_count = 0;
10735 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10736 any_help_event_p = 0;
10737 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10739 #ifdef USE_GTK
10740 current_count = -1;
10741 #endif
10743 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10744 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10746 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10747 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10749 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10751 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10752 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10753 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10754 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10755 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10756 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10757 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10759 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10761 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10762 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10763 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10764 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10765 widgets don't behave normally. */
10767 EMACS_TIME interval;
10768 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10769 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10771 #endif
10773 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10774 #ifndef USE_GTK
10775 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10776 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10777 #endif
10778 #endif
10780 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10781 original error handler. */
10782 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10783 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10785 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10786 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10787 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10788 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10790 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10794 void
10795 syms_of_xterm ()
10797 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10798 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10800 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10801 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10803 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10804 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10806 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10807 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10809 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10810 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10811 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10812 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10814 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10815 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10817 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10818 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10819 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10820 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10821 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10822 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10823 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10825 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10826 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10827 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10828 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10829 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10830 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10831 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10832 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10833 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10835 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10836 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10837 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10838 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10839 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10840 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10841 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10842 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10843 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10844 #elif USE_GTK
10845 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10846 #else
10847 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10848 #endif
10849 #else
10850 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10851 #endif
10853 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10854 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10856 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10857 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10858 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10859 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10860 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10861 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10862 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10863 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10864 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10866 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10867 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10868 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10869 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10870 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10871 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10873 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10874 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10875 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10876 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10877 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10878 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10880 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10881 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10882 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10883 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10884 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10885 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10887 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10888 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10889 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10890 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10891 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10892 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10894 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10895 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10896 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10897 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10898 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10899 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10902 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10904 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10905 (do not change this comment) */